blob: 806ef8b912173fc1d3d9a98ad5e7c322e5f7c941 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8860dcd2014-04-26 00:08:14 +02007 2014/04/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100500 - tune.zlib.memlevel
501 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 * Debugging
504 - debug
505 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506
507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509------------------------------------
510
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511ca-base <dir>
512 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200513 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
514 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516chroot <jail dir>
517 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
518 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
519 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
520 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
521 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
522 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100523
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100524cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
525 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
526 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
527 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100528 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
529 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
530 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
531 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
532 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
533 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
534 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
535 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
536 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
537 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100538
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200539crt-base <dir>
540 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
541 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
542 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544daemon
545 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
546 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
547 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
548
549gid <number>
550 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
551 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
552 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100553 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
554 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557group <group name>
558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
559 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200561log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
563 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 configured with "log global".
565
566 <address> can be one of:
567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
573 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
574 port).
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
578 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
579 writeable).
580
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100581 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
582 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
583 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
584 in Bourne shell.
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
589 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
590 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
591
592 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200593 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
594 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
595 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
596 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
597 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100602log-send-hostname [<string>]
603 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
604 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
605 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
606 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
607 the logs.
608
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000609log-tag <string>
610 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
611 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
612 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
613 running on the same host.
614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615nbproc <number>
616 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
617 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
618 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
619 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
620 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
621
622pidfile <pidfile>
623 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
624 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
625 starting the process. See also "daemon".
626
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100627stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200628 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
629 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
630 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
631 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
632 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
633 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200635 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
636 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200637
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100638ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
640 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100642 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
643 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
644 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
645 "bind" keyword for more information.
646
647ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
649 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300650 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
652 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
653 information.
654
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100655ssl-server-verify [none|required]
656 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
657 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
658 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
659
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200660stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
661 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
662 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
663 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
664 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200665
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200666 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
667 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
668 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
671 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
672 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100673 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200674
675stats maxconn <connections>
676 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
677 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679uid <number>
680 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
681 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
682 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
683 one. See also "gid" and "user".
684
685ulimit-n <number>
686 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
687 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
688 option.
689
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100690unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
691 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
692
693 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
694 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
695 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
696 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
697 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
698 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
699 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
700 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
701 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
702 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704user <user name>
705 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
706 See also "uid" and "group".
707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200708node <name>
709 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
710
711 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
712 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
713 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
714 traffic.
715
716description <text>
717 Add a text that describes the instance.
718
719 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
720 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
721 "<" and ">" characters.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725-----------------------
726
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200727max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
728 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
729 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
730 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
731 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
732 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
733 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
734 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
735 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737maxconn <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
739 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
740 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
741 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
742
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200743maxconnrate <number>
744 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
745 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
746 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
747 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
748 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
749 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
750 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
751 fairness.
752
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753maxcomprate <number>
754 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300755 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100756 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
757 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
758 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
759 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
760 default value.
761
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100762maxcompcpuusage <number>
763 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
764 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
765 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
766 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
767 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
768 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
769 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
770 process down and from introducing high latencies.
771
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100772maxpipes <number>
773 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
774 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
775 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
776 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
777 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
778 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
779
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200780maxsessrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200790maxsslconn <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
792 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
793 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
794 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
795 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
796 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
797 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
798
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200799maxsslrate <number>
800 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
801 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
802 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
803 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
804 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
805 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
806 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
807 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
808 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
809 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
810
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100811maxzlibmem <number>
812 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
813 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
814 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100815 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
816 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
817 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819noepoll
820 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
821 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100822 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
824nokqueue
825 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
826 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
827 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
828
829nopoll
830 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
831 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100832 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100833 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200834
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100835nosplice
836 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
837 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
838 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100839 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100840 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
841 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
842 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
843 "option splice-response".
844
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300845nogetaddrinfo
846 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
847 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
848
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200849spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900850 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
851 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
852 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
853 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
854 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
855 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200856
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200857tune.bufsize <number>
858 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
859 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
860 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
861 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
862 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
863 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
864 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
865 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400866 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200869
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200870tune.chksize <number>
871 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
872 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
873 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
874 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
875 checks whenever possible.
876
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100877tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
878 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
879 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
880 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
881 this value. The default value is 1.
882
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100883tune.http.cookielen <number>
884 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
885 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
886 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
887 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
888 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
889 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
890 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
891 to change this value.
892
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200893tune.http.maxhdr <number>
894 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
895 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
896 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
897 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
898 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
899 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
900 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
901 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
902 limit too high.
903
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100904tune.idletimer <timeout>
905 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
906 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
907 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
908 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
909 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
910 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
911 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
912 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
913 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
914
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100915tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100916 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
917 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
918 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
919 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
920 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
921 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
922 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
923 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
924 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
925 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100926
927tune.maxpollevents <number>
928 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
929 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
930 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
931 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
932 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
933
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200934tune.maxrewrite <number>
935 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
936 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
937 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
938 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
939 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
940 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
941 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
942 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
943 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
944 bufsize.
945
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200946tune.pipesize <number>
947 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
948 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
949 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
950 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
951 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
952 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100954tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
955tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
956 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
957 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
959 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
963
964tune.sndbuf.client <number>
965tune.sndbuf.server <number>
966 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
967 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
968 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
969 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
970 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
971 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
972 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
973 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
974 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
975 notifying haproxy again.
976
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100977tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100978 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
979 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
980 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300981 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100982 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
983 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
984 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
985 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
986 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100987 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
988 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100989
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200990tune.ssl.force-private-cache
991 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
992 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
993 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
994 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
995 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
996 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
997
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100998tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
999 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001001 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1002 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1003 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1004 being used for too long.
1005
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001006tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1007 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1008 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1009 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1010 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1011 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1012 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1013 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1014 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1015 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1016 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001017 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1018 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001019
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001020tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1021 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001022 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001023 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1024 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1025 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1026
1027tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1028 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1029 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1030 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1031 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333.3. Debugging
1034--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036debug
1037 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1038 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1039 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1040 system startup.
1041
1042quiet
1043 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1044 line argument "-q".
1045
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010473.4. Userlists
1048--------------
1049It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1050http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1051it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1052
1053userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001054 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001055 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1056
1057group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001058 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1060 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1063 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001064 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1065 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001066 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1067 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001068 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070
1071
1072 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073 userlist L1
1074 group G1 users tiger,scott
1075 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1078 user scott insecure-password elgato
1079 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001081 userlist L2
1082 group G1
1083 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001084
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001085 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1086 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1087 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088
1089 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001091
10923.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001093----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001094It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1095haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1096pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1097identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1098or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1099Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1100known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1101the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1102process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1103during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1104tables.
1105
1106peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001107 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1109
1110peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1111 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1112 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1113 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1114 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1115 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1116 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1117
1118 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1119 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1120
1121 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1122 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1123 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1124 across all peers.
1125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001126 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1127 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1128 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001130 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001131 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001132 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1133 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1134 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135
1136 backend mybackend
1137 mode tcp
1138 balance roundrobin
1139 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1140 stick on src
1141
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001142 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1143 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001144
1145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1150 - defaults <name>
1151 - frontend <name>
1152 - backend <name>
1153 - listen <name>
1154
1155A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1156its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1157section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
1160A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1161connections.
1162
1163A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1164to forward incoming connections.
1165
1166A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1167parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1170'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1171case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1172
1173Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1174logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1175proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1176However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1177name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1178
1179Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1180and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001181bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001182protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1183modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1184arbitrary criteria.
1185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001186In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1187a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1188the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1189
1190 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1191 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1192 between responses and new requests.
1193
1194 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1195 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1196 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1197 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1198
1199 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1200 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1201 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1202
1203 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1204 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1205 client-facing connection remains open.
1206
1207 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1208 after the end of the response.
1209
1210The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1211frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1212following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1213weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1214
1215 Backend mode
1216
1217 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1218 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1219 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1220 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1221 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1222 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1223 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1224 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1225 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1226 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1227 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1232--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001234The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1235limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1236they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1237limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001239option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001240and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1241with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1242specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001245 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1246------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1247acl - X X X
1248appsession - - X X
1249backlog X X X -
1250balance X - X X
1251bind - X X -
1252bind-process X X X X
1253block - X X X
1254capture cookie - X X -
1255capture request header - X X -
1256capture response header - X X -
1257clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001258compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260cookie X - X X
1261default-server X - X X
1262default_backend X X X -
1263description - X X X
1264disabled X X X X
1265dispatch - - X X
1266enabled X X X X
1267errorfile X X X X
1268errorloc X X X X
1269errorloc302 X X X X
1270-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1271errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273fullconn X - X X
1274grace X X X X
1275hash-type X - X X
1276http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001277http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001278http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001280http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001281http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001282id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001284log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001285max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286maxconn X X X -
1287mode X X X X
1288monitor fail - X X -
1289monitor-net X X X -
1290monitor-uri X X X -
1291option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1292option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1293option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1294option allbackups (*) X - X X
1295option checkcache (*) X - X X
1296option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1297option contstats (*) X X X -
1298option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1299option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1300option forceclose (*) X X X X
1301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1302option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001303option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001304option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001305option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001307option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1309option httpchk X - X X
1310option httpclose (*) X X X X
1311option httplog X X X X
1312option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001313option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001314option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1316option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1317option logasap (*) X X X -
1318option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001319option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320option nolinger (*) X X X X
1321option originalto X X X X
1322option persist (*) X - X X
1323option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001324option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001325option smtpchk X - X X
1326option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1327option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1328option splice-request (*) X X X X
1329option splice-response (*) X X X X
1330option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1331option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001333option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001334option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1335option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1336option tcpka X X X X
1337option tcplog X X X X
1338option transparent (*) X - X X
1339persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1340rate-limit sessions X X X -
1341redirect - X X X
1342redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1343redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1344reqadd - X X X
1345reqallow - X X X
1346reqdel - X X X
1347reqdeny - X X X
1348reqiallow - X X X
1349reqidel - X X X
1350reqideny - X X X
1351reqipass - X X X
1352reqirep - X X X
1353reqisetbe - X X X
1354reqitarpit - X X X
1355reqpass - X X X
1356reqrep - X X X
1357-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1358reqsetbe - X X X
1359reqtarpit - X X X
1360retries X - X X
1361rspadd - X X X
1362rspdel - X X X
1363rspdeny - X X X
1364rspidel - X X X
1365rspideny - X X X
1366rspirep - X X X
1367rsprep - X X X
1368server - - X X
1369source X - X X
1370srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001371stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001372stats auth X - X X
1373stats enable X - X X
1374stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001375stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376stats realm X - X X
1377stats refresh X - X X
1378stats scope X - X X
1379stats show-desc X - X X
1380stats show-legends X - X X
1381stats show-node X - X X
1382stats uri X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1384stick match - - X X
1385stick on - - X X
1386stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001387stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001389tcp-check connect - - X X
1390tcp-check expect - - X X
1391tcp-check send - - X X
1392tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001393tcp-request connection - X X -
1394tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001395tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001396tcp-response content - - X X
1397tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398timeout check X - X X
1399timeout client X X X -
1400timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1401timeout connect X - X X
1402timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1403timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1404timeout http-request X X X X
1405timeout queue X - X X
1406timeout server X - X X
1407timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1408timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001409timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001410transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001411unique-id-format X X X -
1412unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001413use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001414use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1416 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014194.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1420---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001421
1422This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1423
1424
1425acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1426 Declare or complete an access list.
1427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1428 no | yes | yes | yes
1429 Example:
1430 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1431 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1432 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001434 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001435
1436
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001437appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1438 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001439 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1441 no | no | yes | yes
1442 Arguments :
1443 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1444 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1445
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001446 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447 checked in each cookie value.
1448
1449 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1450 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1451 milliseconds.
1452
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001453 request-learn
1454 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1455 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1456 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1457 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1458 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1459 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1460
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001461 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1462 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1463 data following this prefix.
1464
1465 Example :
1466 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1467
1468 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1469 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1470
1471 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1472 2 modes are currently supported :
1473 - path-parameters :
1474 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1475 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1476 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1477 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1478 - query-string :
1479 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1480 query string.
1481
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001482 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1483 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1484 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1485 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001486 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1487 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1488 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1490 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1491
1492 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1493
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001494 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1495 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1496 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001498 Example :
1499 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1500
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001501 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1502 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001503
1504
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001505backlog <conns>
1506 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1508 yes | yes | yes | no
1509 Arguments :
1510 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1511 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001512 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001513
1514 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1515 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1516 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1517 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1518 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1519 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1520 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1521 backlog parameter.
1522
1523 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1524 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1525 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1526
1527 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1528
1529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001531balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1534 yes | no | yes | yes
1535 Arguments :
1536 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1537 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1538 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1539 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1540
1541 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1542 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1543 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1544 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001545 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001546 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001547 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1548 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1549 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1550 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1551 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1552 it, so that you don't worry.
1553
1554 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1555 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1556 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1557 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1558 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1559 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1560 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1561 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001562
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001563 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1564 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1565 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1566 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1567 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1568 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1569 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1570 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1571
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001572 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001573 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001574 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1575 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001576 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001577 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1578 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1579 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1580 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1581 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001582 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1583 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1584 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1585 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1586 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1587 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001589 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1590 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1591 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1592 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1593 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1594 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1595 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1596 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001597 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001599 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1600 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1601 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001602
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001603 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1604 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1605 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1606 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1607 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1608 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1609 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1610 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1611 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1612 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1613 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1614 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001616 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001617 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1618 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1619 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1620 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1621 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1622 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1623 URIs start with a leading "/".
1624
1625 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1626 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1627 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1628 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001630 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001631 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1632
1633 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001634 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1635 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001636 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1637 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1638 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1639 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001640 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001641 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1642 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001643
1644 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1645 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1646 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1647 server will receive the request.
1648
1649 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1650 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1651 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1652 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1653 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001654 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1655 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1656 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001658 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1659 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1660 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1661 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1662 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001664 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001665 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1666 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1667 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1668
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001669 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1670 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1671 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1672
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001673 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001674 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001675 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1676 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1677 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1678 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1679 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1680 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001681 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001682 used instead.
1683
1684 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1685 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1686 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1687 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1688
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001689 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1690 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1691 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1692
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001693 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001696 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1697 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001698
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001699 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1700 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1701 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001702
1703 Examples :
1704 balance roundrobin
1705 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001706 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001707 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1708 balance hdr(host)
1709 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001710
1711 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1712 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001714 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001715 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1716 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1717 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1718 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1719
1720 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1721 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1722 defaults to 16 kB.
1723
1724 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1725 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1726
1727 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1728 Round Robin.
1729
1730 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1731 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1732 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1733 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1734
1735 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1736
1737 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001738 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001739 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1740 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1741 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001742
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001743 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1744 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
1746
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001747bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1748bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1751 no | yes | yes | no
1752 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001753 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1754 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1755 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1756 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001757 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001758 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1759 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1760 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1761 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1762 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1763 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1764 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001765 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1766 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1767 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001768 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1769 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1770 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1771 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001772
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001773 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1774 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001775 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1776 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1777 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001778 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1779 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1780 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1781 the range.
1782
1783 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1784 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1785 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1786 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1787 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1788 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1789 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001790 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001791 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001793 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1794 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1795 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1796 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1797 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1798 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1799 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1800 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1801
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001802 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1803 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1804 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1805 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1808 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1809 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1810 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1811 in a frontend.
1812
1813 Example :
1814 listen http_proxy
1815 bind :80,:443
1816 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001817 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001819 listen http_https_proxy
1820 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001821 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001822
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001823 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1824 bind ipv6@:80
1825 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1826 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1827
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001828 listen external_bind_app1
1829 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1830
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001831 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001832 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833
1834
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001835bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001836 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1838 yes | yes | yes | yes
1839 Arguments :
1840 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1841 may be used to override a default value.
1842
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001843 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001844 option may be combined with other numbers.
1845
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001846 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001847 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1848 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1849 missing from all processes.
1850
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001851 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001852 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001853 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1854 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1855 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1856 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001857
1858 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1859 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1860 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1861 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1862 and 'even' instances.
1863
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001864 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1865 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1866 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1867 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001868
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001869 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1870 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1871
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001872 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1873 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1874
1875 Example :
1876 listen app_ip1
1877 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001878 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001879
1880 listen app_ip2
1881 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001882 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001883
1884 listen management
1885 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001886 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001888 listen management
1889 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1890 bind-process 1-4
1891
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001892 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001893
1894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895block { if | unless } <condition>
1896 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1898 no | yes | yes | yes
1899
1900 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1901 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001902 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001903 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001904 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1905 "block" statements per instance.
1906
1907 Example:
1908 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1909 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1910 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1911 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001913 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001914
1915
1916capture cookie <name> len <length>
1917 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1919 no | yes | yes | no
1920 Arguments :
1921 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1922 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1923 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1924 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1925 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1926
1927 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1928 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1929 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1930 right if it exceeds <length>.
1931
1932 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1933 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1934 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1935 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1936
1937 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1938 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1939 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1940
1941 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1942 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1943 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001944 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1945 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1946 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001947
1948 Example:
1949 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1950
1951 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001952 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
1954
1955capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001956 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1958 no | yes | yes | no
1959 Arguments :
1960 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001961 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1963 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1964 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1965
1966 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1967 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1968 it exceeds <length>.
1969
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001970 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1972 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001973 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1974 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1975 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1976 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001977 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001978 environments to find where the request came from.
1979
1980 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1981 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1982 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1983 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001985 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1986 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1987 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1988 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1989 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001990
1991 Example:
1992 capture request header Host len 15
1993 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1994 capture request header Referrer len 15
1995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001996 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997 about logging.
1998
1999
2000capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002001 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2003 no | yes | yes | no
2004 Arguments :
2005 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002006 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2008 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2009 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2010
2011 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2012 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2013 it exceeds <length>.
2014
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002015 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2017 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2018 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002019 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2020 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2021 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2022 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002024 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2025 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2026 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2027 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2028 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
2030 Example:
2031 capture response header Content-length len 9
2032 capture response header Location len 15
2033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002034 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 about logging.
2036
2037
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002038clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2041 yes | yes | yes | no
2042 Arguments :
2043 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2044 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2045 as explained at the top of this document.
2046
2047 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2048 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2049 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2050 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2051 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2052 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2053 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2054 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002055 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2057 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2058
2059 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2060 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2061 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2062 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2063 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2064 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2065
2066 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2067 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2068
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002069 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2070 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002072compression algo <algorithm> ...
2073compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002074compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002075 Enable HTTP compression.
2076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2077 yes | yes | yes | yes
2078 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002079 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2080 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2081 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2082
2083 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002084 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002085 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2086 data.
2087
2088 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2089 support for zlib was built in.
2090
2091 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2092 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2093 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2094 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2095 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2096 in.
2097
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002098 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002099 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002100 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2101 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2102 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2103 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2104 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002105
2106 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2107 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2108 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2109 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2110 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002111 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2112 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2113 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2114 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2115 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2116 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002117
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002118 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002119 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2120 "Accept-Encoding" header
2121 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002122 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002123 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2124 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002125 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2126 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2127 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2128 "multipart"
2129 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2130 header
2131 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2132 and later
2133 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2134 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002135
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002136 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2137 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002138
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002139 Examples :
2140 compression algo gzip
2141 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002143contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2146 yes | no | yes | yes
2147 Arguments :
2148 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2150 as explained at the top of this document.
2151
2152 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002153 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002154 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2156 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2157 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2158 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2159
2160 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2161 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2162 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2163 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2164 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2165 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2166
2167 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2168 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2169 instead.
2170
2171 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2172 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2173
2174
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002175cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002176 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2177 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002178 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2180 yes | no | yes | yes
2181 Arguments :
2182 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2183 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2184 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2185 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2186 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2187 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2188 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2189 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2190 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2191
2192 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2193 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2194 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2195 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2196 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2197 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2198 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2199 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2200 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2201 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2202 "insert" and "prefix".
2203
2204 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002205 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002206
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002207 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002208 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2209 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2210 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2211 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2212 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2213 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2214 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2215 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2216 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2217 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002218
2219 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2220 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2221 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2222 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2223 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2224 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2225 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2226 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2227 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2228 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002229 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2230 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2231 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002233 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2234 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2235 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002236 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2237 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2238 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2239 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002240 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2241 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2242 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243
2244 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2245 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2246 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2247 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2248 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2249 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2250 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2251 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2252 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2253
2254 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2255 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2256 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2257 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2258 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2259 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2260 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2261 persistence cookie in the cache.
2262 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2263
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002264 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2265 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2266 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2267 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2268 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2269 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2270 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2271 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2272 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2273 they logout.
2274
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002275 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2276 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2277 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2278 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2279
2280 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2281 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2282 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2283 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2284 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2285 this attribute.
2286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002287 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002288 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002289 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2290 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2291 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2292 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2293 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2294 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002295
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002296 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2297 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2298 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2299 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2300 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2301 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2302 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2303 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2304 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2305 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2306 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2307 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2308 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2309 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2310 the site.
2311
2312 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2313 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2314 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2315 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2316 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2317 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2318 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2319 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2320 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2321 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2322 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2323 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2324 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2325 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2326 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2327 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2330 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2331 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2332 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334 Examples :
2335 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2336 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2337 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002338 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002340 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002341 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002344default-server [param*]
2345 Change default options for a server in a backend
2346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2347 yes | no | yes | yes
2348 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002349 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2350 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2351 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2352 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002353
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002354 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002355 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2356
2357 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002360default_backend <backend>
2361 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2363 yes | yes | yes | no
2364 Arguments :
2365 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2366
2367 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2368 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2369 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2370 will catch all undetermined requests.
2371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372 Example :
2373
2374 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2375 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2376 default_backend dynamic
2377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002378 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002381description <string>
2382 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2384 no | yes | yes | yes
2385 Arguments : string
2386
2387 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2388 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2389 it describes.
2390 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2391
2392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393disabled
2394 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2396 yes | yes | yes | yes
2397 Arguments : none
2398
2399 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2400 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2401 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2402 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2403 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2404 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2405 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2406
2407 See also : "enabled"
2408
2409
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002410dispatch <address>:<port>
2411 Set a default server address
2412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2413 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002414 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002415
2416 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2417 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2418 during start-up.
2419
2420 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2421 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2422 possible with normal servers.
2423
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002424 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002425 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2426 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2427 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2428 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2429
2430 See also : "server"
2431
2432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433enabled
2434 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2436 yes | yes | yes | yes
2437 Arguments : none
2438
2439 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2440 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2441
2442 See also : "disabled"
2443
2444
2445errorfile <code> <file>
2446 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2448 yes | yes | yes | yes
2449 Arguments :
2450 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002451 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002452
2453 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002454 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002456 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2457 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458
2459 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2460 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2461 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2462
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002463 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2466 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2467 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2468 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2469
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002470 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2471 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2472 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2473 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2474 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2475 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002477 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2478 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2479 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002480 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002481 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2482
2483 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2484
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002485 Example :
2486 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2487 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2488 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002490
2491errorloc <code> <url>
2492errorloc302 <code> <url>
2493 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2495 yes | yes | yes | yes
2496 Arguments :
2497 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002498 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002499
2500 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2501 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2502 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2503 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2504 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2505
2506 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2507 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2508 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2509
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002510 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002512 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2513 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2514 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2515 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2516 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2517 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2518 request.
2519
2520 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2521
2522
2523errorloc303 <code> <url>
2524 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2526 yes | yes | yes | yes
2527 Arguments :
2528 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2529 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2530
2531 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2532 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2533 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2534 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2535 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2536
2537 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2538 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2539 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2540
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002541 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002543 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2544 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2545 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2546 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002547 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002548
2549 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2550
2551
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002552force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2553 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2555 no | yes | yes | yes
2556
2557 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2558 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2559 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2560 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2561 marked down for maintenance operations.
2562
2563 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2564 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2565 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2566 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2567 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2568 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2569 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2570 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2571 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2572
2573 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2574 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2575 is used.
2576
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002577 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002578 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002579
2580
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002581fullconn <conns>
2582 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2584 yes | no | yes | yes
2585 Arguments :
2586 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2587 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2588
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002589 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002591 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002592 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2593 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2594 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2595 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2596 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002597 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002598
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002599 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2600 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002601 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2602 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2603 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605 Example :
2606 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2607 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2608 # connections.
2609 backend dynamic
2610 fullconn 10000
2611 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2612 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2613
2614 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2615
2616
2617grace <time>
2618 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002621 Arguments :
2622 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2623 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2624 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2625
2626 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2627 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002628 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002629 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2630
2631 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2632 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2633 simplify it.
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002636hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002637 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002641 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2642 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002643
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002644 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2645 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2646 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2647 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2648 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2649 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2650 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2651 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2652 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2653 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002654
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002655 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2656 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2657 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2658 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2659 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2660 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2661 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2662 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2663 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2664 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2665 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2666 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2667 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002668 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2669 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002670
2671 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2672
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002673 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002674 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2675 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2676 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002677 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2678 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2679 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002680
2681 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2682 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002683 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2684 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2685 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2686 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2687
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002688 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2689 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2690 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2691 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2692 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2693 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2694 parameter.
2695
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002696 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2697
2698 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2699 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2700 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2701 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2702 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2703 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2704 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2705 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2706 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2707 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2708 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2709 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002710
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002711 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2712 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2713 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002714
2715 See also : "balance", "server"
2716
2717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718http-check disable-on-404
2719 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002721 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722 Arguments : none
2723
2724 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2725 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2726 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2727 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2728 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2729 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2730 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2731 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002732 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2733 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2734 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2735
2736 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2737
2738
2739http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002740 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002742 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002743 Arguments :
2744 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2745 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002746 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2748 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2749 details on the supported keywords.
2750
2751 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2752 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2753 with the usual backslash ('\').
2754
2755 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2756 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2757 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2758 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2759 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2760
2761 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002762 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002763 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2764 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2765 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2766
2767 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002768 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002769 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2770 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2771 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2772 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2773
2774 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002775 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002776 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2777 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2778 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2779 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2780 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2781 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2782 trace).
2783
2784 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002785 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002786 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2787 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2788 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2789 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2790 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2791 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2792
2793 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2794 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2795 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2796 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2797 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2798 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2799 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2800 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2801
2802 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2803 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2804
2805 Examples :
2806 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002807 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002808
2809 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002810 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002811
2812 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002813 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002814
2815 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002816 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002818 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002819
2820
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002821http-check send-state
2822 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2824 yes | no | yes | yes
2825 Arguments : none
2826
2827 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2828 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2829 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2830 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2831 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2832
2833 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2834 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2835 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2836 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2837 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2838 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2839 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2840 checked in multiple backends.
2841
2842 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2843 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2844
2845 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2846 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2847 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2848 one fails.
2849
2850 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2851 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2852 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2853
2854 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2855 server's queue.
2856
2857 Example of a header received by the application server :
2858 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2859 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2860
2861 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2862
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002863http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002864 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002865 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002866 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2867 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2868 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2869 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2870 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2871 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002873 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2874
2875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2876 no | yes | yes | yes
2877
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002878 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2879 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2880 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2881 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2882 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002884 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2885 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2886 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2887
2888 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2889 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2890 are evaluated.
2891
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002892 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2893 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2894 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2895 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2896 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2897 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2898 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2899 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2900 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002901 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002902 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2903
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002904 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2905 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2906 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2907 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2908 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2909
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002910 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2911 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2912 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002913 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2914 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002915
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002916 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2917 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2918 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2919 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2920 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2921 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2922 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2923 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2924
2925 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2926 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2927 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2928 external users.
2929
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002930 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2931 <name>.
2932
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002933 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2934 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2935 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2936 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2937 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2938 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2939 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2940 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2941
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002942 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2943 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2944 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2945 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2946 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2947 another equipment.
2948
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002949 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2950 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2951 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2952 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2953 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2954 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2955 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2956 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2957
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002958 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2959 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2960 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2961 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2962 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2963 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2964 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2965 admin privileges.
2966
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002967 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2968 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2969 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2970 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2971 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2972 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2973 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2974 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2975
2976 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2977 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2978 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2979 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2980 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2981 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2982
2983 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2984 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2985 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2986 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2987 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2988 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2989
2990 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2991 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2992 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2993 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2994 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2995 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2996 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2997 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
2998 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2999
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003000 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3001
3002 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3003 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3004 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3005 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003006
3007 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003008 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3009 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3010 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003011
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003012 http-request allow if nagios
3013 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3014 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3015 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003016
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003017 Example:
3018 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003019 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003020
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003021 Example:
3022 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3023 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3024 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3025 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3026 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3027 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3031
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003032 Example:
3033 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3034 acl add path /addacl
3035 acl del path /delacl
3036
3037 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3038
3039 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3040 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3041
3042 Example:
3043 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3044 acl setmap path /setmap
3045 acl delmap path /delmap
3046
3047 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3048
3049 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3050 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3051
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003052 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3053 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003054
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003055http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003056 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003057 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3058 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3059 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3060 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3061 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3062 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003063 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003064 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3065
3066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3067 no | yes | yes | yes
3068
3069 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3070 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3071 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3072 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3073 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3074 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3075
3076 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3077 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3078 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3079 current section.
3080
3081 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3082 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3083 rules are evaluated.
3084
3085 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3086 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3087 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3088 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3089 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3090 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3091 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3092
3093 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3094 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3095 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3096 external users.
3097
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003098 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3099 <name>.
3100
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003101 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3102 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3103 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3104 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3105 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3106 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3107 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3108 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3109
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003110 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3111 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3112 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3113 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3114 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3115 another equipment.
3116
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003117 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3118 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3119 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3120 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3121 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3122 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3123 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3124 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3125
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003126 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3127 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3128 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3129 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3130 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3131 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3132 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3133 admin privileges.
3134
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003135 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3136 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3137 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3138 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3139 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3140 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3141 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3142 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3143
3144 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3145 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3146 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3147 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3148 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3149 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3150
3151 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3152 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3153 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3154 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3155 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3156 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3157
3158 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3159 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3160 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3161 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3162 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3163 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3164 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3165 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3166 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3167
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003168 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3169
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003170 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003171 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3172 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3173 rules.
3174
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003175 Example:
3176 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3177
3178 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3179
3180 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3181 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3182
3183 Example:
3184 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3185
3186 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3187
3188 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3189 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3190
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003191 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3192 ACL usage.
3193
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003194
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003195http-send-name-header [<header>]
3196 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3197
3198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3199 yes | no | yes | yes
3200
3201 Arguments :
3202
3203 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3204
3205 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3206 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3207 is added with the header string proved.
3208
3209 See also : "server"
3210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003211id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003212 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3214 no | yes | yes | yes
3215 Arguments : none
3216
3217 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3218 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3219 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003220
3221
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003222ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3223 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 no | yes | yes | yes
3226
3227 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3228 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3229 and running).
3230
3231 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3232 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3233 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003234 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003235 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3236
3237 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3238 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3239
3240 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3241 "unless" condition is met.
3242
3243 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3244
3245
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003246log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003247log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003248no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003249 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3251 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003252
3253 Prefix :
3254 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3255 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3256 prefix does not allow arguments.
3257
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003258 Arguments :
3259 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3260 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3261 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3262 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3263 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3264 parameter.
3265
3266 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3267 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3268
3269 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3270 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3271 standard syslog port).
3272
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003273 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3274 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3275 standard syslog port).
3276
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003277 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3278 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3279 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3280 appropriately writeable).
3281
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003282 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3283 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3284 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3285 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003287 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3288
3289 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3290 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3291 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3292
3293 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3294 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3295 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003296 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3297 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3298 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3299 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3300 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003301
3302 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3303
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003304 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3305 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3306 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003307
3308 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3309 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3310 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3311 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3312
3313 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3314 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003315
3316 Example :
3317 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003318 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3319 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003320 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3321
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003322
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003323log-format <string>
3324 Allows you to custom a log line.
3325
3326 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3327
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003329max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3330 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | no | yes | yes
3333
3334 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3335 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3336 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3337 servers.
3338
3339 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3340 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3341 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3342 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3343 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3344 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3345 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3346 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3347 picking a different server.
3348
3349 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3350 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3351 even if they have to be queued.
3352
3353 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3354 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3355
3356
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003357maxconn <conns>
3358 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3360 yes | yes | yes | no
3361 Arguments :
3362 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3363 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3364 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3365 closes.
3366
3367 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3368 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3369 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3370 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3371 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3372 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3373 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3374 properly tuned.
3375
3376 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3377 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3378 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3379
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003380 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3381
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003382 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3383
3384
3385mode { tcp|http|health }
3386 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3388 yes | yes | yes | yes
3389 Arguments :
3390 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3391 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3392 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3393 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3394
3395 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3396 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3397 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3398 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3399 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3400
3401 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003402 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3403 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3404 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3405 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3406 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3407 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3408 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003409
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003410 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3411 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3412 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003413
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003414 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003415 defaults http_instances
3416 mode http
3417
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003418 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003421monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3424 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425 Arguments :
3426 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3427 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003428 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3430 backend and its backup.
3431
3432 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3433 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3434 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3435 servers in a list of backends.
3436
3437 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3438 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3439 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3440 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3441 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3442 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3443 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003444 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3445 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003446
3447 Example:
3448 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003449 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3451 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3452 monitor-uri /site_alive
3453 monitor fail if site_dead
3454
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003455 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003456
3457
3458monitor-net <source>
3459 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | yes | yes | no
3462 Arguments :
3463 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3464 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3465 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3466 followed by a mask.
3467
3468 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3469 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003470 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003471 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3472
3473 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3474 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3475 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3476 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003477 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3478 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3479 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003480
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003481 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3482 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3483 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3484 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3485 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3486 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003487
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003488 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3489 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003491 Example :
3492 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3493 frontend www
3494 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3495
3496 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3497
3498
3499monitor-uri <uri>
3500 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 yes | yes | yes | no
3503 Arguments :
3504 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3505 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3506
3507 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3508 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3509 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3510 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3511 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3512 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3513 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3514 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3515
3516 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3517 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3518 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3519 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3520 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3521 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3522
3523 Example :
3524 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3525 frontend www
3526 mode http
3527 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3528
3529 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003532option abortonclose
3533no option abortonclose
3534 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | no | yes | yes
3537 Arguments : none
3538
3539 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3540 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3541 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3542 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003543 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003544 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3545 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3546 encountered while delivering the response.
3547
3548 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3549 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3550 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3551 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3552 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3553 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003554 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003555 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003556 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3558 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3559 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3560
3561 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3562 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3563 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3564 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3565 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3566 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3567 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3568 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003569 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003570
3571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3573
3574 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3575
3576
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003577option accept-invalid-http-request
3578no option accept-invalid-http-request
3579 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 yes | yes | yes | no
3582 Arguments : none
3583
3584 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3585 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3586 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3587 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3588 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3589 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3590 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3591 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003592 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3593 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3594 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3595 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3596 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3597 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003598
3599 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3600 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3601 been confirmed.
3602
3603 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3604 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003605 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3606 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003607 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3608
3609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3611
3612 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3613 stats socket.
3614
3615
3616option accept-invalid-http-response
3617no option accept-invalid-http-response
3618 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 yes | no | yes | yes
3621 Arguments : none
3622
3623 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3624 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3625 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3626 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3627 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3628 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3629 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3630 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3631 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3632
3633 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3634 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3635 been confirmed.
3636
3637 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3638 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3639 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3640 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3641
3642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3644
3645 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3646 stats socket.
3647
3648
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003649option allbackups
3650no option allbackups
3651 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | no | yes | yes
3654 Arguments : none
3655
3656 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3657 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3658 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3659 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3660 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3661 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3662 order between the backup servers anymore.
3663
3664 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3665 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3666
3667 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3668 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3669
3670
3671option checkcache
3672no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003673 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3675 yes | no | yes | yes
3676 Arguments : none
3677
3678 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3679 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003680 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003681 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3682 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003683 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684
3685 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003686 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003687 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003688 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3689 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003690 to the client are :
3691 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003692 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003693 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003694 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3695 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3696 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3697 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3698 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3699 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3700 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3701 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3702 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3703 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3704 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3705
3706 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003707 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003708 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003709 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003710 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3711
3712 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3713 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003714 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003715 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3716
3717 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3718 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3719
3720
3721option clitcpka
3722no option clitcpka
3723 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | yes | yes | no
3726 Arguments : none
3727
3728 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3729 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3730 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3731 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3732
3733 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3734 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3735 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3736 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3737
3738 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3739 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3740 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3741 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3742 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3743
3744 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3745
3746 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3747 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3748 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3749
3750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3752
3753 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3754
3755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756option contstats
3757 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | no
3760 Arguments : none
3761
3762 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3763 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3764 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3765 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3766 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3767 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3768 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3769
3770
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003771option dontlog-normal
3772no option dontlog-normal
3773 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | yes | yes | no
3776 Arguments : none
3777
3778 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3779 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3780 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3781 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3782 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3783 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3784 logged.
3785
3786 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3787 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3788 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003790 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003791 logging.
3792
3793
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003794option dontlognull
3795no option dontlognull
3796 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | yes | yes | no
3799 Arguments : none
3800
3801 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3802 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3803 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3804 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3805 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3806 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3807 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3808
3809 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3810 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3811 would not be logged.
3812
3813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003816 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003817
3818
3819option forceclose
3820no option forceclose
3821 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003823 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003824 Arguments : none
3825
3826 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3827 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3828 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3829 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3830 global session times in the logs.
3831
3832 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003833 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003834 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003835
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003836 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3837 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3838 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3839
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003840 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3841 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003842
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3845
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003846 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003847
3848
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003849option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003850 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3852 yes | yes | yes | yes
3853 Arguments :
3854 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3855 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003856 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003857 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003858
3859 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3860 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3861 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3862 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3863 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3864 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3865 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003866 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3867 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3868 possible that the client has already brought one.
3869
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003870 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003871 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003872 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3873 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003874 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3875 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003876
3877 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3878 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3879 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3880 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3881 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3882 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3883 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3884
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003885 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3886 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3887 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3888 are under the control of the end-user.
3889
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003890 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003891 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3892 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003893 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3894 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3895 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003896
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003897 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003898 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3899 frontend www
3900 mode http
3901 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3902
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003903 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3904 backend www
3905 mode http
3906 option forwardfor header X-Client
3907
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003908 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003909 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003910
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003911
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003912option http-keep-alive
3913no option http-keep-alive
3914 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | yes
3917 Arguments : none
3918
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003919 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3920 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3921 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3922 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3923 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3924 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3925 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3926
3927 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3928 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003929 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3930 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3931 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3932 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3933 situations where this option may be useful :
3934
3935 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3936 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3937
3938 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3939 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3940
3941 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3942 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3943 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3944 request.
3945
3946 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3947 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003948 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3949 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3950 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003951
3952 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3953 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3954
3955 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3956 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3957 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3958 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3959 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3960 not set.
3961
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003962 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3963 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003964 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003965 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003966
3967 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003968 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3969 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003970
3971
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003972option http-no-delay
3973no option http-no-delay
3974 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 yes | yes | yes | yes
3977 Arguments : none
3978
3979 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3980 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3981 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3982 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3983 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3984 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3985 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3986 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3987 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3988 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3989 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3990 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3991 affected.
3992
3993 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3994 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3995 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3996 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3997 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3998 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3999 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4000 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4001 latency environments.
4002
4003
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004004option http-pretend-keepalive
4005no option http-pretend-keepalive
4006 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | yes | yes | yes
4009 Arguments : none
4010
4011 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4012 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4013 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4014 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4015 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4016 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4017 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4018 consider the response complete.
4019
4020 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4021 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4022 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4023 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4024 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4025 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4026
4027 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4028 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4029 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4030 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4031 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4032 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4033 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4034
4035 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4036 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004037 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004038 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4039 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004040
4041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4043
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004044 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4045 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004046
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004047
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004048option http-server-close
4049no option http-server-close
4050 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 yes | yes | yes | yes
4053 Arguments : none
4054
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004055 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4056 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4057 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4058 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4059 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4060 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4061 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4062 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4063 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4064 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4065 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4066 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4067 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4068 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4069 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4070 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004071
4072 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4073 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4074 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4075 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004076 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4077 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004078
4079 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4080 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004081 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4082 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004083 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4084 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004085
4086 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4087 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4088
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004089 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004090 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4091 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004094option http-tunnel
4095no option http-tunnel
4096 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004101 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4102 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4103 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4104 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4105 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4106 "option http-tunnel".
4107
4108 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004109 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004110 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4111 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4112 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4113 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4114 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4115 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4116 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004117
4118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4120
4121 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4122 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4123 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4124
4125
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004126option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004127no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004128 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | yes | yes | no
4131 Arguments : none
4132
4133 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4134 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4135 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4136 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4137 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4138 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4139 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4140
4141 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4142 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4143 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4144 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4145 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4146 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4147 request along its whole life.
4148
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004149 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4150 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4151 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4152 front of an existing proxy.
4153
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004154 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4155
4156 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4157 http-server-close".
4158
4159
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004160option httpchk
4161option httpchk <uri>
4162option httpchk <method> <uri>
4163option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4164 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 yes | no | yes | yes
4167 Arguments :
4168 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4169 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4170 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4171 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4172 ones.
4173
4174 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4175 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4176 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4177
4178 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4179 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4180 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4181 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4182 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4183
4184 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4185 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4186 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4187 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4188 the lack of any response.
4189
4190 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4191
4192 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4193 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4194 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4195
4196 Examples :
4197 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4198 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4199 backend https_relay
4200 mode tcp
4201 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4202 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4203
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004204 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4205 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4206 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004207
4208
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004209option httpclose
4210no option httpclose
4211 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4213 yes | yes | yes | yes
4214 Arguments : none
4215
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004216 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4217 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4218 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4219 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004220 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004221 "option http-tunnel".
4222
4223 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4224 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4225 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4226 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4227 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4228 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4229 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4230 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004231
4232 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004233 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004234 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4235 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4236 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4237 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4238 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004239
4240 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4241 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004242 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4243 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004244 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4245 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004246
4247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4249
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004250 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4251 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004252
4253
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004254option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004255 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4257 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004258 Arguments :
4259 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4260 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4261 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4262 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4263 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004264
4265 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4266 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4267 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4268 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4269 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4270 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4271 ports.
4272
4273 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4274
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4277 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4278 by default.
4279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004280 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004281
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004282
4283option http_proxy
4284no option http_proxy
4285 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4287 yes | yes | yes | yes
4288 Arguments : none
4289
4290 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4291 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4292 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4293 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4294 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4295
4296 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4297 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4298 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4299 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004300 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004301 be analyzed.
4302
4303 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4304 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4305
4306 Example :
4307 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4308 backend direct_forward
4309 option httpclose
4310 option http_proxy
4311
4312 See also : "option httpclose"
4313
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004314
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004315option independent-streams
4316no option independent-streams
4317 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | yes
4320 Arguments : none
4321
4322 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4323 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4324 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4325 receive data or not.
4326
4327 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4328 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4329 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4330 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4331 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4332 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4333 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4334 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4335 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4336 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4337 socket buffers.
4338
4339 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4340 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4341 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4342 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4343 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4344
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004345 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004346 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4347 deprecated.
4348
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004349 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004350
4351
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004352option ldap-check
4353 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 yes | no | yes | yes
4356 Arguments : none
4357
4358 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4359 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4360 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4361 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4362
4363 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4364 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4365
4366 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4367 configure it.
4368
4369 Example :
4370 option ldap-check
4371
4372 See also : "option httpchk"
4373
4374
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004375option log-health-checks
4376no option log-health-checks
4377 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | no | yes | yes
4380 Arguments : none
4381
4382 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4383 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4384 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4385 of additional information is limited.
4386
4387 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4388 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4389
4390 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4391
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004392
4393option log-separate-errors
4394no option log-separate-errors
4395 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | no
4398 Arguments : none
4399
4400 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4401 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4402 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4403 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4404 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4405 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4406 provides very important information.
4407
4408 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4409 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4410 error logs.
4411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004412 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004413 logging.
4414
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004415
4416option logasap
4417no option logasap
4418 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | yes | yes | no
4421 Arguments : none
4422
4423 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4424 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4425 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4426 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4427 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4428 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4429 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004430 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004431 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4432 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004434 Examples :
4435 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4436 mode http
4437 option httplog
4438 option logasap
4439 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4440
4441 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4442 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4443 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4444 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004446 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004447 logging.
4448
4449
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004450option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4451 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4453 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004454 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004455 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4456 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004457
4458 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4459 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4460 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4461 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4462 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4463 in the MySQL table, like this :
4464
4465 USE mysql;
4466 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4467 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4468
4469 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4470 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4471 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4472 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4473 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4474 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4475 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4476 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4477 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4478
4479 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4480 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004481
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004482 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004483
4484 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4485 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4486 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4487 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4488 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4489 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4490
4491 See also: "option httpchk"
4492
4493
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004494option nolinger
4495no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004496 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004499 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004500
4501 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4502 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4503 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4504 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4505 connections.
4506
4507 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4508 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4509 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4510 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4511 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4512 this too.
4513
4514 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4515 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4516 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4517
4518 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4519 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4520 for servers.
4521
4522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4524
4525
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004526option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4527 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 yes | yes | yes | yes
4530 Arguments :
4531 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4532 matching <network>
4533 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4534 header name.
4535
4536 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4537 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4538 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4539 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4540 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4541 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4542 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4543 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4544 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4545 possible that the client has already brought one.
4546
4547 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4548 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4549 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4550 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4551 header and requires different one.
4552
4553 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4554 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4555 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4556 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4557 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4558 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4559 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4560
4561 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4562 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4563 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4564 both are defined.
4565
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004566 Examples :
4567 # Original Destination address
4568 frontend www
4569 mode http
4570 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4571
4572 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4573 backend www
4574 mode http
4575 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4576
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004577 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4578 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004579
4580
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004581option persist
4582no option persist
4583 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4584 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004586 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004587
4588 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4589 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4590 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4591 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4592 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4593 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4594 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4595 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4596 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4597 redirected to another valid server.
4598
4599 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4600 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4601
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004602 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004603
4604
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004605option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4606 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | no | yes | yes
4609 Arguments :
4610 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4611 PostgreSQL server.
4612
4613 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4614 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4615 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4616 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4617
4618 See also: "option httpchk"
4619
4620
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004621option prefer-last-server
4622no option prefer-last-server
4623 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 yes | no | yes | yes
4626 Arguments : none
4627
4628 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4629 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4630 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4631 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4632 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4633 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4634 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4635 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4636 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004637 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4638 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4639 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4640 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4641 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4642 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4643 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004644
4645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4647
4648 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4649
4650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004651option redispatch
4652no option redispatch
4653 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004656 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004657
4658 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4659 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4660 be able to access the service anymore.
4661
4662 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4663 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4664
4665 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4666 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4667 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004669 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4670 "redisp" keywords.
4671
4672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4674
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004675 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004676
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004677
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004678option redis-check
4679 Use redis health checks for server testing
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 yes | no | yes | yes
4682 Arguments : none
4683
4684 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4685 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4686 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4687 find the "+PONG" response message.
4688
4689 Example :
4690 option redis-check
4691
4692 See also : "option httpchk"
4693
4694
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004695option smtpchk
4696option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4697 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4699 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004700 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004701 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4702 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4703 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4704
4705 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4706 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4707 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4708
4709 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4710 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4711 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4712 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4713 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4714 dead server.
4715
4716 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4717 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4718 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4719 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4720
4721 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4722 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4723 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4724 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4725 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4726
4727 Example :
4728 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4729
4730 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004733option socket-stats
4734no option socket-stats
4735
4736 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 yes | yes | yes | no
4739
4740 Arguments : none
4741
4742
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004743option splice-auto
4744no option splice-auto
4745 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4751 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4752 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4753 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004754 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004755 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4756 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4757 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4758 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4759
4760 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4761 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4762 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4763 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4764 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4765 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4766 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4767 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4768 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4769 keyword.
4770
4771 Example :
4772 option splice-auto
4773
4774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4776
4777 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4778 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4779
4780
4781option splice-request
4782no option splice-request
4783 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | yes
4786 Arguments : none
4787
4788 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004789 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004790 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4791 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4792 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4793 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4794
4795 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4796
4797 Example :
4798 option splice-request
4799
4800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4802
4803 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4804 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4805
4806
4807option splice-response
4808no option splice-response
4809 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | yes
4812 Arguments : none
4813
4814 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004815 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004816 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4817 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4818 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4819 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4820
4821 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4822
4823 Example :
4824 option splice-response
4825
4826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4828
4829 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4830 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4831
4832
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004833option srvtcpka
4834no option srvtcpka
4835 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | no | yes | yes
4838 Arguments : none
4839
4840 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4841 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4842 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4843 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4844
4845 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4846 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4847 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4848 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4849
4850 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4851 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4852 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4853 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4854 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4855
4856 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4857
4858 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4859 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4860 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4861
4862 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4863 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4864
4865 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4866
4867
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004868option ssl-hello-chk
4869 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4871 yes | no | yes | yes
4872 Arguments : none
4873
4874 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4875 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4876 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4877 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4878 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4879 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4880 hello message.
4881
4882 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4883 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4884 messages, which is appreciable.
4885
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004886 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4887 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4888 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004889
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004890 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4891
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004892
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004893option tcp-check
4894 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4896 yes | no | yes | yes
4897
4898 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4899 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4900
4901 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4902 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4903 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4904
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004905 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004906 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4907 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4908 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4909 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4910 only.
4911
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004912 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004913 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4914 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4915 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4916 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4917
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004918 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004919 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4920 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004921 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004922 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4923 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4924 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4925 the respective protocols.
4926 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4927 analysed.
4928
4929 Examples :
4930 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4931 option tcp-check
4932 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4933
4934 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4935 option tcp-check
4936 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4937
4938 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4939 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004940 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004941 option tcp-check
4942 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4943 tcp-check expect +PONG
4944 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4945 tcp-check expect string role:master
4946 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4947 tcp-check expect string +OK
4948
4949 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4950 (send many headers before analyzing)
4951 option tcp-check
4952 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4953 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4954 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4955 tcp-check send \r\n
4956 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4957
4958
4959 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4960
4961
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004962option tcp-smart-accept
4963no option tcp-smart-accept
4964 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | yes | yes | no
4967 Arguments : none
4968
4969 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4970 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4971 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4972 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4973 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4974 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4975
4976 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4977 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4978 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4979 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4980
4981 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4982 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4983 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4984 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4985
4986 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4987 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4988 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4989
4990 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4991 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4992 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4993
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004994 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4995
4996
4997option tcp-smart-connect
4998no option tcp-smart-connect
4999 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | no | yes | yes
5002 Arguments : none
5003
5004 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5005 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5006 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5007 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5008 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5009
5010 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5011 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5012 complex.
5013
5014 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5015 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5016 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5017
5018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5020
5021 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5022
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005023
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005024option tcpka
5025 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | yes | yes | yes
5028 Arguments : none
5029
5030 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5031 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5032 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5033 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5034
5035 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5036 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5037 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5038 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5039
5040 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5041 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5042 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5043 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5044 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5045
5046 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5047
5048 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5049 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5050 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5051 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5052 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5053 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5054 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5055 backends.
5056
5057 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5058
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005059
5060option tcplog
5061 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | yes | yes | yes
5064 Arguments : none
5065
5066 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5067 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5068 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5069 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5070 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5071 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5072 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5073 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5074
5075 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005077 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005078
5079
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005080option transparent
5081no option transparent
5082 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005084 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005085 Arguments : none
5086
5087 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5088 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5089 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5090 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5091 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5092 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5093 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5094 appropriate server.
5095
5096 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5097 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5098
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005099 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005100 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005101
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005102
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005103persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005104persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005105 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5107 yes | no | yes | yes
5108 Arguments :
5109 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005110 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5111 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005112
5113 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5114 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5115 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5116 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5117 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5118 forwarded to this server.
5119
5120 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5121 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5122 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005123 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005124 a single "listen" section.
5125
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005126 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5127 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5128 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5129
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005130 Example :
5131 listen tse-farm
5132 bind :3389
5133 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5134 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5135 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5136 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5137 persist rdp-cookie
5138 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005139 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005140 balance rdp-cookie
5141 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5142 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5143
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005144 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5145 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005146
5147
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005148rate-limit sessions <rate>
5149 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5151 yes | yes | yes | no
5152 Arguments :
5153 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5154 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5155
5156 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5157 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5158 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5159 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5160 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5161 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5162
5163 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5164 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5165 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5166 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5167
5168 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5169 listen smtp
5170 mode tcp
5171 bind :25
5172 rate-limit sessions 10
5173 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5174
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005175 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5176 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5177 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005178
5179 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5180
5181
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005182redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5183redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5184redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005185 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 no | yes | yes | yes
5188
5189 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005190 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005191
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005192 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005193 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005194 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5195 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5196 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005197
5198 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5199 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5200 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5201 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5202 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005203 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5204 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5205 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5206 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005207
5208 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5209 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5210 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5211 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5212 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5213 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005214 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005215 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005216 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5217 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5218 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005219
5220 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005221 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5222 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5223 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5224 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5225 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5226 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5227 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5228 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005229
5230 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5231 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5232
5233 - "drop-query"
5234 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5235 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5236 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5237 with a location-type redirect.
5238
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005239 - "append-slash"
5240 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5241 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5242 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5243 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5244
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005245 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5246 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5247 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5248 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5249 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5250 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5251 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5252
5253 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5254 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5255 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5256 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5257 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5258 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5259 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005260
5261 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5262 acl clear dst_port 80
5263 acl secure dst_port 8080
5264 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005265 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005266 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005267 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5268
5269 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005270 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5271 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5272 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005273 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005274
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005275 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5276 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5277 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5278
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005279 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005280 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005281
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005282 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5283 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5284 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005286 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005287
5288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005289redisp (deprecated)
5290redispatch (deprecated)
5291 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005294 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005295
5296 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5297 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5298 be able to access the service anymore.
5299
5300 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5301 redistribute them to a working server.
5302
5303 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5304 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5305 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005307 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5308 "option redispatch" instead.
5309
5310 See also : "option redispatch"
5311
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005312
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005313reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005314 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 no | yes | yes | yes
5317 Arguments :
5318 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5319 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005320 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005321
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005322 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5323 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5324
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005325 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5326 the last header of an HTTP request.
5327
5328 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5329 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5330 responses.
5331
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005332 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5333 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5334 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5335
5336 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5337 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005338
5339
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005340reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5341reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005342 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5344 no | yes | yes | yes
5345 Arguments :
5346 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5347 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5348 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5349 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5350 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5351 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5352 ignores case.
5353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005354 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5355 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5356
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005357 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5358 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5359 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5360 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005361 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005362
5363 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5364 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5365
5366 Example :
5367 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5368 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5369 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005371 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5372 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005373
5374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005375reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5376reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005377 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5379 no | yes | yes | yes
5380 Arguments :
5381 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5382 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5383 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5384 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5385 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5386 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005388 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5389 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5390
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005391 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5392 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5393 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5394 next servers.
5395
5396 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5397 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5398 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5399
5400 Example :
5401 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5402 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5403 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5404
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005405 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5406 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005407
5408
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005409reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5410reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005411 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5413 no | yes | yes | yes
5414 Arguments :
5415 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5416 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5417 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5418 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5419 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5420 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5421 case.
5422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005423 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5424 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5425
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005426 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5427 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5428 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5429 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005430 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005431
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005432 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005433 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005434 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005436 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5437 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5438
5439 Example :
5440 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5441 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5442 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5443
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005444 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5445 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005446
5447
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005448reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5449reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005450 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5452 no | yes | yes | yes
5453 Arguments :
5454 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5455 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5456 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5457 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5458 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5459 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5460 case.
5461
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005462 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5463 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5464
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005465 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5466 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5467 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5468 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5469
5470 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5471 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5472
5473 Example :
5474 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5475 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5476 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5477 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5478
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005479 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5480 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005481
5482
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005483reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5484reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005485 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 no | yes | yes | yes
5488 Arguments :
5489 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5490 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5491 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5492 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5493 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5494 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5495
5496 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5497 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5498 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5499 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005500 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005502 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5503 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5504
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005505 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5506 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5507 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5508
5509 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5510 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5511 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5512 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5513 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5514
5515 Example :
5516 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005517 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005518 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5519 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5520
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005521 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5522 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005523
5524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005525reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5526reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005527 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5529 no | yes | yes | yes
5530 Arguments :
5531 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5532 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5533 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5534 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5535 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5536 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5537 ignores case.
5538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005539 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5540 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5541
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005542 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5543 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005544 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5545 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5546 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005547 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5548 not set.
5549
5550 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5551 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5552 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5553 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5554 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005556 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005557 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5558 # block all others.
5559 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5560 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005562 # block bad guys
5563 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5564 reqitarpit . if badguys
5565
5566 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5567 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005568
5569
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005570retries <value>
5571 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5573 yes | no | yes | yes
5574 Arguments :
5575 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5576 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5577 default value is 3.
5578
5579 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5580 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5581 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5582
5583 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5584 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5585
5586 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5587 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5588
5589 See also : "option redispatch"
5590
5591
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005592rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005593 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 no | yes | yes | yes
5596 Arguments :
5597 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5598 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005599 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005600
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005601 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5602 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5603
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005604 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5605 the last header of an HTTP response.
5606
5607 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5608 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5609 responses.
5610
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005611 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5612 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005613
5614
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005615rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5616rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005617 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 no | yes | yes | yes
5620 Arguments :
5621 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5622 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5623 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5624 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5625 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5626 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5627 ignores case.
5628
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005629 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5630 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5631
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5633 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005634 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005635 client.
5636
5637 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5638 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5639 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5640
5641 Example :
5642 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005643 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005644
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005645 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5646 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005647
5648
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005649rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5650rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005651 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5653 no | yes | yes | yes
5654 Arguments :
5655 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5656 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5657 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5658 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5659 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5660 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5661 ignores case.
5662
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005663 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5664 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005666 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5667 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5668 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5669 case-sensitive.
5670
5671 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005672 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5673 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5674 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005675
5676 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5677 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5678
5679 Example :
5680 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5681 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5682
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005683 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5684 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685
5686
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005687rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5688rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005689 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 no | yes | yes | yes
5692 Arguments :
5693 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5694 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5695 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5696 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5697 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5698 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5699 ignores case.
5700
5701 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5702 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5703 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5704 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005705 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005706
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005707 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5708 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5709
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005710 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5711 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5712 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5713
5714 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5715 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5716 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5717 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5718 are not case-sensitive.
5719
5720 Example :
5721 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5722 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5723
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005724 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5725 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005726
5727
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005728server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005729 Declare a server in a backend
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 no | no | yes | yes
5732 Arguments :
5733 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005734 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005735 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005736
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005737 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5738 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5739 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5740 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005741 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5742 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5743 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5744 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5745 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005746 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5747 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5748 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5749 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5750 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5751 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5752 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005753 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5754 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5755 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5756 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005758 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005759 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5760 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5761 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5762 adding this value to the client's port.
5763
5764 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5765 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005766 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005767
5768 Examples :
5769 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5770 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005771 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005772 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5773 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5774 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005775
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005776 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5777 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005778
5779
5780source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005781source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005782source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005783 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5785 yes | no | yes | yes
5786 Arguments :
5787 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5788 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005789
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005790 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005791 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5792 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5793 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5794 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5795 supported prefixes are :
5796 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5797 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5798 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005799 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5800 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5801 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5802 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005803
5804 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5805 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005806 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5807 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5808 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005809
5810 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5811 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5812 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5813 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5814 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5815 <addr>.
5816
5817 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5818 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5819 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5820 port.
5821
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005822 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5823 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5824 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5825 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005826 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005827 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5828 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5829 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5830 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5831 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5832 HTTP header.
5833
5834 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5835 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005836 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005837 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5838 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5839 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5840 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5841 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5842 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5843 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5844
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005845 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5846 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5847 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5848 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5849 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5850 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5851
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005852 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5853 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5854 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5855 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5856
5857 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5858 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5859 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5860 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5861 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5862 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5863
5864 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5865 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5866 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5867 there are two methods :
5868
5869 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5870 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5871 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5872 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5873 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5874 of the client ranges may be used.
5875
5876 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5877 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5878 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5879 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5880 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5881 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5882 same session.
5883
5884 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5885 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5886 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5887 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5888 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5889 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5890
5891 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5892 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5893 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005894 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005895
5896 Examples :
5897 backend private
5898 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5899 source 192.168.1.200
5900
5901 backend transparent_ssl1
5902 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5903 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5904
5905 backend transparent_ssl2
5906 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5907 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5908 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5909
5910 backend transparent_ssl3
5911 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5912 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5913 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5914
5915 backend transparent_smtp
5916 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5917 # with Tproxy version 4.
5918 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5919
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005920 backend transparent_http
5921 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5922 # proxy.
5923 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005925 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005926 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005928
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005929srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5930 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | no | yes | yes
5933 Arguments :
5934 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5935 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5936 as explained at the top of this document.
5937
5938 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5939 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5940 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5941 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5942 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5943 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5944 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5945
5946 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5947 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5948 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5949 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5950 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005951 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005952 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005953 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005954
5955 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5956 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5957 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5958 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5959 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5960 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5961
5962 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5963 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5964
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005965 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5966 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005967
5968
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005969stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5970 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005972 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005973
5974 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5975 matched.
5976
5977 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5978 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5979
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005980 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5981 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5982 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5983
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005984 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5985 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5986 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5987 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005988
5989 Example :
5990 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5991 backend stats_localhost
5992 stats enable
5993 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5994
5995 Example :
5996 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5997 backend stats_auth
5998 stats enable
5999 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6000 stats admin if TRUE
6001
6002 Example :
6003 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6004 userlist stats-auth
6005 group admin users admin
6006 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6007 group readonly users haproxy
6008 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6009
6010 backend stats_auth
6011 stats enable
6012 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6013 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6014 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6015 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6016
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006017 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6018 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6019 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006020
6021
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006022stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6023 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006026 Arguments :
6027 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6028
6029 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6030
6031 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6032 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6033 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6034 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6035 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6036 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6037
6038 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6039 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6040 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006041 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006042
6043 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6044 report using "stats scope".
6045
6046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6048 unobvious parameters.
6049
6050 Example :
6051 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6052 backend public_www
6053 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6054 stats enable
6055 stats hide-version
6056 stats scope .
6057 stats uri /admin?stats
6058 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6059 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6060 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6061
6062 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6063 backend private_monitoring
6064 stats enable
6065 stats uri /admin?stats
6066 stats refresh 5s
6067
6068 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6069
6070
6071stats enable
6072 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006074 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006075 Arguments : none
6076
6077 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6078 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6079 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6080 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6081 - stats auth : no authentication
6082 - stats scope : no restriction
6083
6084 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6085 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6086 unobvious parameters.
6087
6088 Example :
6089 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6090 backend public_www
6091 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6092 stats enable
6093 stats hide-version
6094 stats scope .
6095 stats uri /admin?stats
6096 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6097 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6098 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6099
6100 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6101 backend private_monitoring
6102 stats enable
6103 stats uri /admin?stats
6104 stats refresh 5s
6105
6106 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6107
6108
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006109stats hide-version
6110 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006112 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006113 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006114
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006115 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6116 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6117 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6118 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6119 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6120 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6124 unobvious parameters.
6125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006126 Example :
6127 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6128 backend public_www
6129 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006130 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006131 stats hide-version
6132 stats scope .
6133 stats uri /admin?stats
6134 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6135 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6136 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006137
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006138 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6139 backend private_monitoring
6140 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006141 stats uri /admin?stats
6142 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006143
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006144 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006145
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006146
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006147stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6149 Access control for statistics
6150
6151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6152 no | no | yes | yes
6153
6154 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6155 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6156 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6157 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6158 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6159 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6160
6161 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6162 instance.
6163
6164 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6165 about ACL usage.
6166
6167
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006168stats realm <realm>
6169 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006171 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006172 Arguments :
6173 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6174 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6175 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6176
6177 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6178 using a backslash ('\').
6179
6180 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6181 only related to authentication.
6182
6183 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6184 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6185 unobvious parameters.
6186
6187 Example :
6188 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6189 backend public_www
6190 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6191 stats enable
6192 stats hide-version
6193 stats scope .
6194 stats uri /admin?stats
6195 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6196 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6197 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6198
6199 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6200 backend private_monitoring
6201 stats enable
6202 stats uri /admin?stats
6203 stats refresh 5s
6204
6205 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6206
6207
6208stats refresh <delay>
6209 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006211 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006212 Arguments :
6213 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6214 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6215 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6216 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6217 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6218 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6219
6220 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6221 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6222 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6223 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6224
6225 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6226 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6227 unobvious parameters.
6228
6229 Example :
6230 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6231 backend public_www
6232 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6233 stats enable
6234 stats hide-version
6235 stats scope .
6236 stats uri /admin?stats
6237 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6238 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6239 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6240
6241 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6242 backend private_monitoring
6243 stats enable
6244 stats uri /admin?stats
6245 stats refresh 5s
6246
6247 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6248
6249
6250stats scope { <name> | "." }
6251 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006253 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006254 Arguments :
6255 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6256 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6257 section in which the statement appears.
6258
6259 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6260 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6261 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6262 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6263 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6264 exists.
6265
6266 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6267 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6268 unobvious parameters.
6269
6270 Example :
6271 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6272 backend public_www
6273 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6274 stats enable
6275 stats hide-version
6276 stats scope .
6277 stats uri /admin?stats
6278 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6279 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6280 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6281
6282 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6283 backend private_monitoring
6284 stats enable
6285 stats uri /admin?stats
6286 stats refresh 5s
6287
6288 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006290
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006291stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006292 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006294 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006296 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006297 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6298
6299 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6300 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6301
6302 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6303 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006304 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006305
6306 Example :
6307 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6308 backend private_monitoring
6309 stats enable
6310 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6311 stats uri /admin?stats
6312 stats refresh 5s
6313
6314 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6315 global section.
6316
6317
6318stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006319 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments : none
6323
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006324 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006325 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6326 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6327 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6328 - IP (socket, server)
6329 - cookie (backend, server)
6330
6331 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6332 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006333 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006334
6335 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6336
6337
6338stats show-node [ <name> ]
6339 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006341 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006342 Arguments:
6343 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6344 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6345
6346 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6347 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006348 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006349
6350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6352 unobvious parameters.
6353
6354 Example:
6355 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6356 backend private_monitoring
6357 stats enable
6358 stats show-node Europe-1
6359 stats uri /admin?stats
6360 stats refresh 5s
6361
6362 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6363 section.
6364
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006365
6366stats uri <prefix>
6367 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006370 Arguments :
6371 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6372 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6373 query string.
6374
6375 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6376 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6377 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6378 possible to reach it in the application.
6379
6380 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006381 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006382 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6383 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6384 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6385 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6386
6387 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6388 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6389 an address or a port to statistics only.
6390
6391 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6392 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6393 unobvious parameters.
6394
6395 Example :
6396 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6397 backend public_www
6398 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6399 stats enable
6400 stats hide-version
6401 stats scope .
6402 stats uri /admin?stats
6403 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6404 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6405 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6406
6407 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6408 backend private_monitoring
6409 stats enable
6410 stats uri /admin?stats
6411 stats refresh 5s
6412
6413 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6414
6415
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006416stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6417 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006419 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006420
6421 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006422 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006423 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6424 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6425 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6426
6427 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6428 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6429 the "stick-table" statement.
6430
6431 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6432 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6433 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6434 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6435 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6436
6437 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6438 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6439 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6440 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6441 transformation rules.
6442
6443 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6444 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6445 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6446 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6447 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6448 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6449 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6450
6451 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6452 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6453 ACL based conditions.
6454
6455 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6456 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6457 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6458 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6459
6460 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6461 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6462 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6463 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6464
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006465 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6466 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6467 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6468
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006469 Example :
6470 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6471 # last 30 minutes
6472 backend pop
6473 mode tcp
6474 balance roundrobin
6475 stick store-request src
6476 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6477 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6478 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6479
6480 backend smtp
6481 mode tcp
6482 balance roundrobin
6483 stick match src table pop
6484 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6485 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6486
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006487 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6488 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006489
6490
6491stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6492 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 no | no | yes | yes
6495
6496 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6497 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6498 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6499 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6500
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006501 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6502 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6503 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6504
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006505 Examples :
6506 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006507 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006508
6509 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6510 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6511 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6512
6513
6514 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6515 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6516 backend http
6517 mode http
6518 balance roundrobin
6519 stick on src table https
6520 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6521 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6522 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6523
6524 backend https
6525 mode tcp
6526 balance roundrobin
6527 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6528 stick on src
6529 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6530 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006532 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006533
6534
6535stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6536 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6538 no | no | yes | yes
6539
6540 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006541 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006542 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6543 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6544 server is selected.
6545
6546 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6547 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6548 the "stick-table" statement.
6549
6550 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6551 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6552 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6553 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6554 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6555 address.
6556
6557 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6558 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6559 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6560 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6561 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6562 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6563 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6564 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6565 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6566 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6567
6568 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6569 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6570 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6571 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6572 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6573 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6574 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6575
6576 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6577 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6578 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6579 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6580
6581 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6582 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6583 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6584 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6585 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6586 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006587 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6588 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6589 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6590 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6591 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6592 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006593
6594 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6595 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6596 the request.
6597
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006598 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6599 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6600 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6601
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006602 Example :
6603 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6604 # last 30 minutes
6605 backend pop
6606 mode tcp
6607 balance roundrobin
6608 stick store-request src
6609 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6610 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6611 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6612
6613 backend smtp
6614 mode tcp
6615 balance roundrobin
6616 stick match src table pop
6617 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6618 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6619
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006620 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6621 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006622
6623
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006624stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006625 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6626 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006627 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006629 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006630
6631 Arguments :
6632 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6633 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6634 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6635 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6636
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006637 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6638 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6639 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6640 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6641
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006642 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6643 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6644 instance.
6645
6646 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6647 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6648 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6649 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6650 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6651 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006652 to 32 characters.
6653
6654 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6655 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6656 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6657 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6658 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6659 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006660
6661 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006662 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6663 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006664 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6665 increase.
6666
6667 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006668 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6669 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6670 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006671
6672 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6673 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6674 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6675 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6676 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6677 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6678 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6679 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6680 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6681 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6682 parameter (see below).
6683
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006684 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6685 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6686 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6687 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6688 soft restart.
6689
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006690 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6691
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006692 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6693 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6694 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6695 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6696 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006697 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006698 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6699 if not expiration delay is specified.
6700
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006701 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6702 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6703 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6704 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006705 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6706 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6707 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6708 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6709 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6710 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6711 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6712 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6713 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6714 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6715 types and their arguments.
6716
6717 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6718 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6719 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6720 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6721
6722 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6723 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6724 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6725 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6726
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006727 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6728 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6729 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6730 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6731 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6732 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6733
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006734 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6735 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6736 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6737 they were received.
6738
6739 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6740 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6741 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6742 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6743 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6744
6745 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6746 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6747 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6748 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6749 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6750
6751 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6752 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6753 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6754
6755 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6758 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6759 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6760
6761 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6762 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6763 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6764 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6765 the client side.
6766
6767 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6770 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6771 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6772 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6773 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6774
6775 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6776 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6777 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6778 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6779 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6780 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6781 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6782
6783 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6784 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6786 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6787 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6788 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6789
6790 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6791 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6792 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6793 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6794
6795 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6798 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6799 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6800 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6801 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6802 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6803 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6804 recommended for better fairness.
6805
6806 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6807 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6808 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6809 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6810
6811 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6812 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6813 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6814 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6815 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6816 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6817 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6818 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6819 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6820 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006821
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006822 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6823 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006824 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6825 reference it.
6826
6827 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6828 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6829 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6830 as an exclusive stickiness.
6831
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006832 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6833 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6834 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6835 something that can be ignored.
6836
6837 Example:
6838 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6839 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6840 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6841 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6842
6843 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006844 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006845
6846
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006847stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6848 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 no | no | yes | yes
6851
6852 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006853 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006854 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6855 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6856 server is selected.
6857
6858 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6859 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6860 the "stick-table" statement.
6861
6862 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6863 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6864 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6865 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6866
6867 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6868 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6869 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6870 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6871 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6872 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006873 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006874 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6875 rules.
6876
6877 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6878 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6879 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6880 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6881 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6882 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6883 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6884
6885 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6886 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6887 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6888 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6889
6890 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6891 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6892 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6893 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6894 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6895 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006896 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6897 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6898 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6899 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6900 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6901 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6902 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6903 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6904 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006905
6906 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6907
6908 Example :
6909 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6910 backend https
6911 mode tcp
6912 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006913 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006914 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006915
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006916 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6917 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6918
6919 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6920 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6921 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6922
6923 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6924 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006925
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006926 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6927 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6928 # at offset 44.
6929
6930 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6931 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6932
6933 # Learn on response if server hello.
6934 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006935
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006936 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6937 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6938
6939 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6940 extraction.
6941
6942
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006943tcp-check connect [params*]
6944 Opens a new connection
6945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6946 no | no | yes | yes
6947
6948 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6949 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6950 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6951
6952 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6953 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6954 of the sequence.
6955
6956 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6957 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6958 do.
6959
6960 Parameters :
6961 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6962 use the TCP connection.
6963
6964 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6965 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6966 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6967
6968 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6969
6970 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6971
6972 Examples:
6973 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6974 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6975 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6976 option tcp-check
6977 tcp-check connect
6978 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6979 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6980 tcp-check send \r\n
6981 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6982 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6983 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6984 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6985 tcp-check send \r\n
6986 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6987 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6988
6989 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
6990 option tcp-check
6991 tcp-check connect port 110
6992 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
6993 tcp-check connect port 143
6994 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
6995 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
6996
6997 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
6998
6999
7000tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7001 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7003 no | no | yes | yes
7004
7005 Arguments :
7006 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7007 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7008 binary.
7009 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7010 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7011 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7012
7013 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7014 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7015 with the usual backslash ('\').
7016 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7017 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7018 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7019 used upper or lower case.
7020
7021
7022 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7023
7024 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7025 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7026 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7027 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7028 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7029 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7030 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7031 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7032
7033 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7034 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7035 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7036 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7037 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7038 expression.
7039
7040 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7041 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7042 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7043 this exact hexadecimal string.
7044 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7045
7046 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7047 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7048 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7049 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7050 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7051 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7052 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7053 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7054 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7055 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7056 the null character.
7057
7058 Examples :
7059 # perform a POP check
7060 option tcp-check
7061 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7062
7063 # perform an IMAP check
7064 option tcp-check
7065 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7066
7067 # look for the redis master server
7068 option tcp-check
7069 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7070 tcp-check expect +PONG
7071 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7072 tcp-check expect string role:master
7073 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7074 tcp-check expect string +OK
7075
7076
7077 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7078 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7079
7080
7081tcp-check send <data>
7082 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7083 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7084 no | no | yes | yes
7085
7086 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7087 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7088
7089 Examples :
7090 # look for the redis master server
7091 option tcp-check
7092 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7093 tcp-check expect string role:master
7094
7095 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7096 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7097
7098
7099tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7100 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7101 tcp health check
7102 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7103 no | no | yes | yes
7104
7105 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7106 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7107 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7108 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7109 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7110 hexadecimal string.
7111 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7112
7113 Examples :
7114 # redis check in binary
7115 option tcp-check
7116 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7117 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7118
7119
7120 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7121 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7122
7123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007124tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7125 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7127 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007128 Arguments :
7129 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007130 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7131 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007133 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007134
7135 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7136 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007137 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7138 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7139 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7140 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7141 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7142 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007144 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7145 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7146 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7147 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007149 Three types of actions are supported :
7150 - accept :
7151 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7152 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7153 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007154
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007155 - reject :
7156 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7157 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7158 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7159 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7160 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7161 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7162 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7163 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7164 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7165 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7166 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7167 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007168
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007169 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7170 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7171 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7172 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7173 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7174 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7175 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7176 hosts.
7177
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007178 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007179 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7180 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7181 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007182 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7183 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007184 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007185 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7186 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7187 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7188 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7189 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007191 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007192 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007193 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007194 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7195 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7196 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7197 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007199 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7200 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7201 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7202 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007204 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7205 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7206 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7207 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7208 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007209 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7210 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7211 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7212 layer7 information is extracted.
7213
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007214 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7215 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7216 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7217 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7218 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007220 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7221 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7222 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007224 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7225 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7226 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007228 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007229 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007230 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007232 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7233 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7234 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007236 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007237 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7238 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007239
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007240 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7241
7242 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7243
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007244 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007246 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007247
7248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007249tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7250 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007252 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007253 Arguments :
7254 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007255 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7256 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007257 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007259 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007261 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7262 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7263 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7264 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7265 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007267 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7268 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7269 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7270 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007271 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7272 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7273 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7274 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7275 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7276 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007277 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007278 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007280 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7281 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7282 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7283 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007285 Three types of actions are supported :
7286 - accept :
7287 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007288 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007290 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7291 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007292
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007293 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7294 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7295 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7296 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7297 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7298 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007300 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007301 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7302 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007304 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007305 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7306 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7307 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7308 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007309 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7310 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7311 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007312
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007313 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7314 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7315 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7316 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7317
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007318 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007319 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7320 # and reject everything else.
7321 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7322 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007323 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007324 tcp-request content reject
7325
7326 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007327 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7328 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7329 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007330 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007331
7332 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7333 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7334 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007335 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007336 tcp-request content reject
7337
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007338 Example:
7339 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7340 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007341 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007342
7343 Example:
7344 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7345 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007346 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007347
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007348 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7349 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7350
7351 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007352 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 # protecting all our sites
7354 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007355 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7356 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007357 ...
7358 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7359
7360 backend http_dynamic
7361 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007362 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007363 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007364 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7365 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7366 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007367 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007369 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007371 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007372
7373
7374tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7375 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007377 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007378 Arguments :
7379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7381 as explained at the top of this document.
7382
7383 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7384 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7385 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7386 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7387 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7388
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007389 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7390 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7391 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7392 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7393
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007394 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7395 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007396 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007397 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007398 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7399 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7400 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7401 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007402
7403 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7404 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7405 it pass through unaffected.
7406
7407 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7408 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7409 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007410 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007411 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7412 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007413 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7414 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7415 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007416
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007417 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007418 "timeout client".
7419
7420
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007421tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7422 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7424 no | no | yes | yes
7425 Arguments :
7426 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007427 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007428
7429 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7430
7431 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7432 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7433 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007434 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7435 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007436
7437 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7438
7439 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7440 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7441 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7442 inserted.
7443
7444 Two types of actions are supported :
7445 - accept :
7446 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7447 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7448 the rules evaluation.
7449
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007450 - close :
7451 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7452 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7453 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7454 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7455 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7456 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007457 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007458 protocols.
7459
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007460 - reject :
7461 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7462 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007463 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007464
7465 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7466 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7467 for changing the default action to a reject.
7468
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007469 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7470 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7471 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7472 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007473 period.
7474
7475 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7476
7477 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7478
7479
7480tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7481 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7483 no | no | yes | yes
7484 Arguments :
7485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7487 as explained at the top of this document.
7488
7489 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7490
7491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007492timeout check <timeout>
7493 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7494 established.
7495
7496 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7497 yes | no | yes | yes
7498 Arguments:
7499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7501 as explained at the top of this document.
7502
7503 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7504 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7505 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7506 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007507 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7508 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7509 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007510
7511 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7512 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7513
7514 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7515 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007516 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007517
7518 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7519 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7520 forget about it.
7521
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007522 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7523 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007524
7525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007526timeout client <timeout>
7527timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7528 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7530 yes | yes | yes | no
7531 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007532 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007533 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7534 as explained at the top of this document.
7535
7536 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7537 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7538 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7539 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7540 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7541 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7542 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7543 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007544 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007545 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007546 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7547 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7548 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007549
7550 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7551 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7552 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7553 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7554 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7555 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7556
7557 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7558 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7559 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7560
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007561 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007562
7563
7564timeout connect <timeout>
7565timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7566 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7568 yes | no | yes | yes
7569 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7572 as explained at the top of this document.
7573
7574 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007575 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007576 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007577 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007578 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7579 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007580
7581 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7582 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7583 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7584 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7585 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7586 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7587
7588 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7589 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7590 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7591
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007592 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7593 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007594
7595
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007596timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7597 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | yes | yes | yes
7600 Arguments :
7601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7603 as explained at the top of this document.
7604
7605 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7606 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7607 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7608 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7609 once the request has started to present itself.
7610
7611 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7612 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7613 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7614 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7615 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7616
7617 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7618 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7619 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7620 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7621
7622 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7623 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7624 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7625 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7626 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007627 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007628
7629 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7630 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7631 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7632 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7633
7634 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7635
7636
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007637timeout http-request <timeout>
7638 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007640 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007641 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007642 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007643 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7644 as explained at the top of this document.
7645
7646 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7647 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7648 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7649 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7650 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7651 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7652 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7653 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7654
7655 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7656 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007657 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7658 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007659
7660 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7661 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7662 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7663 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7664 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7665
7666 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007667 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7668 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7669 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007670
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007671 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007672
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007673
7674timeout queue <timeout>
7675 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7677 yes | no | yes | yes
7678 Arguments :
7679 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7680 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7681 as explained at the top of this document.
7682
7683 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7684 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7685 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7686 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7687 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7688
7689 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7690 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7691 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7692 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7693
7694 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7695
7696
7697timeout server <timeout>
7698timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7699 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7701 yes | no | yes | yes
7702 Arguments :
7703 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7704 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7705 as explained at the top of this document.
7706
7707 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7708 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7709 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7710 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7711 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7712 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7713 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7714
7715 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7716 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7717 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7718 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7719 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007720 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007721 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007722 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7723 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7724 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7725 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007726
7727 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7728 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7729 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7730 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7731 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7732 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7733
7734 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7735 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7736 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7737
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007738 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007739
7740
7741timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007742 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 yes | yes | yes | yes
7745 Arguments :
7746 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7747 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7748 as explained at the top of this document.
7749
7750 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7751 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7752 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7753
7754 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7755 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7756 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7757 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007758 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007759
7760 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7761
7762
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007763timeout tunnel <timeout>
7764 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7766 yes | no | yes | yes
7767 Arguments :
7768 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7770 as explained at the top of this document.
7771
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007772 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007773 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7774 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7775 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7776 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7777 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7778 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7779 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7780 specified.
7781
7782 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7783 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7784 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7785 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7786 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7787
7788 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7789 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7790 forget about it.
7791
7792 Example :
7793 defaults http
7794 option http-server-close
7795 timeout connect 5s
7796 timeout client 30s
7797 timeout client 30s
7798 timeout server 30s
7799 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7800
7801 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7802
7803
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007804transparent (deprecated)
7805 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007808 Arguments : none
7809
7810 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7811 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7812 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7813 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7814 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7815 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7816 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7817 appropriate server.
7818
7819 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7820
7821 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7822 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7823
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007824 See also: "option transparent"
7825
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007826unique-id-format <string>
7827 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 yes | yes | yes | no
7830 Arguments :
7831 <string> is a log-format string.
7832
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007833 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7834 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7835 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7836 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007837
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007838 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7839 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7840 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7841 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7842 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7843 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7844 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7845 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007846
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007847 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7848 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007849
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007850 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007851
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007852 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007853
7854 will generate:
7855
7856 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7857
7858 See also: "unique-id-header"
7859
7860unique-id-header <name>
7861 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 yes | yes | yes | no
7864 Arguments :
7865 <name> is the name of the header.
7866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007867 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7868 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007870 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007871
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007872 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007873 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7874
7875 will generate:
7876
7877 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7878
7879 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007880
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007881use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007882 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7884 no | yes | yes | no
7885 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007886 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7887 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007888
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007889 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7890 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007891
7892 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7893 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7894 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007895 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7896 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7897 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7898 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007899
7900 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7901 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7902 assign the backend.
7903
7904 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7905 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7906 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7907 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7908 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7909 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7910
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007911 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007912 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007913 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7914 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7915 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7916
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007917 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7918 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7919 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7920 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7921 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7922 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7923 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7924 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7925 cannot be forced from the request.
7926
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007927 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007928 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7929 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7930
7931 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7932 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007933
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007934
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007935use-server <server> if <condition>
7936use-server <server> unless <condition>
7937 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 no | no | yes | yes
7940 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007941 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007942
7943 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7944
7945 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7946 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7947 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7948
7949 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7950 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7951 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7952 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7953 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7954 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7955 matches will assign the server.
7956
7957 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7958 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7959 with the next rules until one matches.
7960
7961 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7962 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7963 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7964 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7965
7966 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7967 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7968 stripped.
7969
7970 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7971 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7972 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7973 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7974
7975 Example :
7976 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7977 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7978 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7979 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7980 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7981 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7982 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7983 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7984 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7985
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007986 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007987
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007988
79895. Bind and Server options
7990--------------------------
7991
7992The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7993depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7994settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7995written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7996described in this section.
7997
7998
79995.1. Bind options
8000-----------------
8001
8002The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8003as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8004no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8005parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8006while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8007provided immediately after the setting name.
8008
8009The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8010
8011accept-proxy
8012 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8013 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8014 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8015 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8016 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8017 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8018 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8019 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8020 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008021 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8022 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008023
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008024alpn <protocols>
8025 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8026 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8027 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8028 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8029 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8030 initial NPN extension.
8031
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008032backlog <backlog>
8033 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8034 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8035
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008036ecdhe <named curve>
8037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008038 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8039 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008040
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008041ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008042 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8043 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8044 client's certificate.
8045
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008046ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8048 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8049 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8050 error is ignored.
8051
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008052ciphers <ciphers>
8053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8054 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008055 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008056 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8057 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8058
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008059crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8061 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8062 to verify client's certificate.
8063
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008064crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8066 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8067 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8068 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8069 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8070 file.
8071
8072 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8073 are loaded.
8074
8075 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8076 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8077 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8078 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8079 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8080 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8081 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8082 www.sub.example.org).
8083
8084 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8085 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8086 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8087 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8088 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8089
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008090 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008091
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008092 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8093 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008094 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008095 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8096 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8097 clients).
8098
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008099crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008100 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8101 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008102 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008103 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008104
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008105crt-list <file>
8106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008107 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8108 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008109
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008110 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008111
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008112 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8113 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8114 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8115 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8116 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8117 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8118 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8119 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008120
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008121defer-accept
8122 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8123 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8124 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8125 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8126 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8127 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8128 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8129 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8130 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8131 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8132 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8133
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008134force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008135 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008136 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8137 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8138
8139force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008140 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008141 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8142
8143force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008144 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008145 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8146
8147force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008148 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008149 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8150
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008151gid <gid>
8152 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8153 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8154 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8155 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8156 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8157
8158group <group>
8159 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8160 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8161 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8162 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8163 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8164
8165id <id>
8166 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8167 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8168 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8169 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8170
8171interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008172 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8173 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8174 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8175 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8176 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8177 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8178 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008179
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008180level <level>
8181 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8182 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8183 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8184 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8185 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8186 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8187 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8188 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8189 counters).
8190 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8191 all counters).
8192
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008193maxconn <maxconn>
8194 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8195 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8196 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8197 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8198 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8199 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8200 eat all memory.
8201
8202mode <mode>
8203 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8204 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8205 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8206 UNIX sockets.
8207
8208mss <maxseg>
8209 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8210 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8211 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8212 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8213 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8214 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8215 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8216 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8217 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8218 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8219 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8220
8221name <name>
8222 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8223 page.
8224
8225nice <nice>
8226 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8227 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8228 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8229 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8230 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8231 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8232 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8233 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8234 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8235 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8236 one for an RDP socket.
8237
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008238no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008240 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008241 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008242 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8243 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008244
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008245no-tls-tickets
8246 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8247 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8248 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8249 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8250
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008251no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008253 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008254 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8255 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8256 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008257
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008258no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008260 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008261 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8262 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8263 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008264
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008265no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008267 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008268 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8269 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8270 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008271
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008272npn <protocols>
8273 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8274 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8275 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8276 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008277 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8278 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008279
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008280process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8281 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8282 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8283 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8284 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8285 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8286 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8287 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008288 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8289 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8290 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8291 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8292 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8293 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8294 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008295
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008296ssl
8297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008298 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008299 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8300 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8301 to deciphered contents.
8302
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008303strict-sni
8304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8305 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8306 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8307 See the "crt" option for more information.
8308
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008309tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008310 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008311 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8312 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8313 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8314 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8315 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8316 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8317 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008318 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8319 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8320 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008321
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008322transparent
8323 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8324 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8325 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8326 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8327 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8328 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8329 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8330 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8331 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8332 so check for support with your vendor.
8333
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008334v4v6
8335 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8336 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8337 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8338 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008339 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008340
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008341v6only
8342 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8343 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8344 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008345 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8346 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008348uid <uid>
8349 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8350 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8351 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8352 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8353 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8354
8355user <user>
8356 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8357 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8358 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8359 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8360 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8361
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008362verify [none|optional|required]
8363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8364 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8365 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8366 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8367 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008368 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8369 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8370 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8371 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020083735.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008374------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008376The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8377which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8378arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8379settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8380after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8381Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8382address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008384 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008385 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008386
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008387The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008388
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008389addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008390 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8391 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8392 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8393 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8394 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008396 Supported in default-server: No
8397
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008398agent-check
8399 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8400 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8401 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8402 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8403
8404 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8405 e.g. "75%"
8406
8407 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8408 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8409
8410 * The string "drain".
8411
8412 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8413 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8414 persistence.
8415
8416 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8417
8418 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8419
8420 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8421
8422 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8423
8424 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8425
8426 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8427
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008428 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8429 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8430 parameter.
8431
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008432 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8433 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8434
8435 Supported in default-server: No
8436
8437agent-inter <delay>
8438 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8439 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8440
8441 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8442 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8443 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8444 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8445 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8446 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8447 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8448 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8449 of backends use the same servers.
8450
8451 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8452
8453 Supported in default-server: Yes
8454
8455agent-port <port>
8456 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8457
8458 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8459
8460 Supported in default-server: Yes
8461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008462backup
8463 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8464 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8465 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8466 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8467 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8468 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008470 Supported in default-server: No
8471
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008472ca-file <cafile>
8473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8474 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8475 server's certificate.
8476
8477 Supported in default-server: No
8478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008479check
8480 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008481 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8482 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8483 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8484 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8485 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8486 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8487 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008488 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8489 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8490 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008492 Supported in default-server: No
8493
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008494check-send-proxy
8495 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8496 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8497 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8498 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8499 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8500 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8501 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8502
8503 Supported in default-server: No
8504
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008505check-ssl
8506 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8507 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8508 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8509 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008510 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008511 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8512 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8513 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8514 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8515
8516 Supported in default-server: No
8517
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008518ciphers <ciphers>
8519 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008520 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008521 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8522 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8523 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8524 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8525 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8526 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8527
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008528 Supported in default-server: No
8529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008530cookie <value>
8531 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8532 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8533 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8534 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8535 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8536 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8537 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008539 Supported in default-server: No
8540
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008541crl-file <crlfile>
8542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8543 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8544 to verify server's certificate.
8545
8546 Supported in default-server: No
8547
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008548crt <cert>
8549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8550 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8551 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8552 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8553 certificate request.
8554
8555 Supported in default-server: No
8556
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008557disabled
8558 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8559 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8560 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8561 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8562 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8563
8564 Supported in default-server: No
8565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008566error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008567 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8568 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8569 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008571 Supported in default-server: Yes
8572
8573 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008575fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008576 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8577 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8578 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008580 Supported in default-server: Yes
8581
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008582force-sslv3
8583 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8584 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8585 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8586
8587 Supported in default-server: No
8588
8589force-tlsv10
8590 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8591 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8592
8593 Supported in default-server: No
8594
8595force-tlsv11
8596 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8597 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8598
8599 Supported in default-server: No
8600
8601force-tlsv12
8602 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8603 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8604
8605 Supported in default-server: No
8606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008607id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008608 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8609 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8610 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008612 Supported in default-server: No
8613
8614inter <delay>
8615fastinter <delay>
8616downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008617 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8618 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8619 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8620 between checks depending on the server state :
8621
8622 Server state | Interval used
8623 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8624 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8625 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8626 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8627 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8628 or yet unchecked. |
8629 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8630 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8631 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008633 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8634 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8635 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8636 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008637 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8638 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8639 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8640 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8641 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008643 Supported in default-server: Yes
8644
8645maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008646 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8647 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8648 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8649 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8650 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8651 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8652 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8653 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008655 Supported in default-server: Yes
8656
8657maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008658 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8659 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8660 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8661 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8662 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8663 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8664 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008666 Supported in default-server: Yes
8667
8668minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8670 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8671 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8672 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8673 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8674 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008675 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008676 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008678 Supported in default-server: Yes
8679
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008680no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008681 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8682 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008683 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008684
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008685 Supported in default-server: No
8686
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008687no-tls-tickets
8688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8689 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8690 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8691 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8692
8693 Supported in default-server: No
8694
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008695no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008696 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008697 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8698 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008699 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8700 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008701
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008702 Supported in default-server: No
8703
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008704no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008705 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008706 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8707 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008708 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8709 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008710
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008711 Supported in default-server: No
8712
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008713no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008714 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008715 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8716 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008717 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8718 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008719
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008720 Supported in default-server: No
8721
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008722non-stick
8723 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8724 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8725 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8726
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008727 Supported in default-server: No
8728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008729observe <mode>
8730 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8731 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8732 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8733 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8734 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8735 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008736 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008738 Supported in default-server: No
8739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008740 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008742on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008743 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8744 Currently, four modes are available:
8745 - fastinter: force fastinter
8746 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8747 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8748 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8749 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008751 Supported in default-server: Yes
8752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008753 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8754
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008755on-marked-down <action>
8756 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8757 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008758 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8759 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8760 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8761 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8762 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8763 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8764 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8765 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008766
8767 Actions are disabled by default
8768
8769 Supported in default-server: Yes
8770
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008771on-marked-up <action>
8772 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8773 Currently one action is available:
8774 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8775 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8776 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8777 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8778 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8779 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8780 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8781 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8782
8783 Actions are disabled by default
8784
8785 Supported in default-server: Yes
8786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008787port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008788 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8789 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8790 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8791 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8792 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8793 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008795 Supported in default-server: Yes
8796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008797redir <prefix>
8798 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8799 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8800 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8801 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8802 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8803 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8804 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8805 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008806 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008807 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8808 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8809 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8810 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8811 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8812
8813 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008815 Supported in default-server: No
8816
8817rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008818 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8819 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8820 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008822 Supported in default-server: Yes
8823
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008824send-proxy
8825 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8826 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8827 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8828 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8829 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8830 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8831 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8832 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8833 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008834 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8835 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8836 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8837 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8838 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008839
8840 Supported in default-server: No
8841
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008842send-proxy-v2
8843 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8844 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8845 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8846 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8847 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8848 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8849 option of the "bind" keyword.
8850
8851 Supported in default-server: No
8852
8853send-proxy-v2-ssl
8854 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8855 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8856 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8857 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8858 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8859 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8860 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8861 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8862
8863 Supported in default-server: No
8864
8865send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8866 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8867 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8868 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8869 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8870 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8871 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8872 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8873 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8874 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8875
8876 Supported in default-server: No
8877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008878slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008879 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8880 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8881 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8882 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8883 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8884 parameters :
8885
8886 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8887 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8888
8889 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8890 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8891 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8892 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8893
8894 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8895 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8896 seen as failed.
8897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008898 Supported in default-server: Yes
8899
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008900source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008901source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008902source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8904 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8905 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8906 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8907
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008908 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8909 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8910 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8911 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8912 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8913 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8914 server.
8915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008916 Supported in default-server: No
8917
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008918ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008919 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8920 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8921 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8922 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8923 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8924 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008925 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008926
8927 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008929track [<proxy>/]<server>
8930 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8931 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8932 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8933 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8934 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008936 Supported in default-server: No
8937
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008938verify [none|required]
8939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008940 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8941 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8942 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8943 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008944 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8945 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8946 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008947
8948 Supported in default-server: No
8949
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008950verifyhost <hostname>
8951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8952 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8953 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8954 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8955 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8956 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8957
8958 Supported in default-server: No
8959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008960weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008961 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8962 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8963 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008964 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8965 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8966 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8967 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8968 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8969 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008971 Supported in default-server: Yes
8972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973
89746. HTTP header manipulation
8975---------------------------
8976
8977In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8978response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8979request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8980which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008981against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008982
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008983If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8984to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8985but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8986HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8987stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8988because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8989a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8990still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008992This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8993in section 4.2 :
8994
8995 - reqadd <string>
8996 - reqallow <search>
8997 - reqiallow <search>
8998 - reqdel <search>
8999 - reqidel <search>
9000 - reqdeny <search>
9001 - reqideny <search>
9002 - reqpass <search>
9003 - reqipass <search>
9004 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9005 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9006 - reqtarpit <search>
9007 - reqitarpit <search>
9008 - rspadd <string>
9009 - rspdel <search>
9010 - rspidel <search>
9011 - rspdeny <search>
9012 - rspideny <search>
9013 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9014 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9015
9016With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9017is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9018parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9019prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9020Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9021
9022 \t for a tab
9023 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9024 \n for a new line (LF)
9025 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9026 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9027 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9028 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9029 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9030
9031The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9032portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9033above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9034regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
90359 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9036is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9037
9038The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9039after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9040
9041Notes related to these keywords :
9042---------------------------------
9043 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9044 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9045 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9046
9047 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9048 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9049 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9050
9051 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9052 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9053 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9054 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9055 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9056
9057 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9058 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9059 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9060 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9061 useless headers before adding new ones.
9062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009063 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009064 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9065
9066 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9067 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9068 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9069
9070 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9071 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009072 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009073
9074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9076----------------------------------
9077
9078Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9079client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9080The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9081these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9082but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9083data called patterns.
9084
9085
90867.1. ACL basics
9087---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088
9089The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9090content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9091from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9092simple :
9093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009094 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009095 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009096 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9097 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009099The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9100adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009101
9102In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009104 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009105
9106This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9107Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9108and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009109an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9110conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9111as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9112are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009113
9114ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9115'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9116which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9117
9118There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9119performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009121The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9122specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9123this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009124methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9125ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009126
9127Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9128 - boolean
9129 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9130 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9131 - string
9132 - data block
9133
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009134Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9135converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9136would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9137The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9138which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009140The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9141 - boolean
9142 - integer or integer range
9143 - IP address / network
9144 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9145 - regular expression
9146 - hex block
9147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009148The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9149
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009150 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9151 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009152 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009153 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009154 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009155 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009156 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009158The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9159read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9160if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9161lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9162will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9163beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9164a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9165lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9166exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9167
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009168The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9169parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9170ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9171a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9172check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9173
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009174The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9175socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9176file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009178Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9179loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9180
9181 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9182
9183In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9184the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9185case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9186as well.
9187
9188The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9189sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9190do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9191methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9192is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9193obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9194followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9195default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9196that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9197string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9198
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009199The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9200By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9201string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9202resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9203server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9204waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9205flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9206function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009208There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9209sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9210be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009211
9212 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9213 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009214 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9215 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9216 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9217 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009218
9219 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9220 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009221 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009222
9223 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009224 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009225
9226 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009227 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009228
9229 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9230 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9231
9232 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9233 binary or string samples.
9234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009235 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9236 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009238 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9239 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9240 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009242 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9243 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009245 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9246 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009248 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9249 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009251 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9252 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009253 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009255 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9256 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9257 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009258
9259For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9260request, it is possible to do :
9261
9262 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9263
9264In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9265buffer, one would use the following acl :
9266
9267 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9268
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009269On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9270possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9271
9272 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009274All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9275criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9276method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9277to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9278criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9279the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009281If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009282the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9283For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009285 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9286 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9287 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9288 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009289
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009290
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009291The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009292and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9293combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9294the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009296 +-------------------------------------------------+
9297 | Input sample type |
9298 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9299 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9300 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9301 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9302 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009303 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009305 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009307 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009309 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009311 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009313 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009315 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009317 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009319 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009321 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009323 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9325 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009327
9328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093297.1.1. Matching booleans
9330------------------------
9331
9332In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9333Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9334When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9335that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9336
9337Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9338return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9339"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9340
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093427.1.2. Matching integers
9343------------------------
9344
9345Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9346enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9347to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9348
9349Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9350matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9351lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009352
9353For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9354unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9355representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9356
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009357As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9358two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9359instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9360ranges and operators.
9361
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009362For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009363operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9364Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9365of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009367Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009368
9369 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9370 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9371 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9372 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9373 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009375For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009376
9377 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9378
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009379This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9380
9381 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9382
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093847.1.3. Matching strings
9385-----------------------
9386
9387String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9388different forms :
9389
9390 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9391 patterns ;
9392
9393 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9394 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9395
9396 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9397 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9398
9399 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9400 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9401
9402 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9403 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9404 matches.
9405
9406 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9407 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9408 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009409
9410String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9411exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9412characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9413string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9414to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009415before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009416
9417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094187.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9419---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009420
9421Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9422they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9423possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9424passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9425the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009426the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9427match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009428
9429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094307.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9431-------------------------------------
9432
9433It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9434not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9435a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9436to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9437digits may be used upper or lower case.
9438
9439Example :
9440 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9441 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9442
9443
94447.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9445---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009446
9447IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9448netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9449within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009450host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009451difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9452at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9453does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9454parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009455
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009456IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9457Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9458trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9459IPv6 patterns.
9460
9461HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9462following situations :
9463 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9464 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9465 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9466 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9467 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9468 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9469 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9470 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9471 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9472 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009474
94757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9476----------------------------------
9477
9478Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9479combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9480
9481 - AND (implicit)
9482 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9483 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009485A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009487 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009489Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9490indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009492For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9493"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9494requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9495is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9496
9497 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9498 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9499 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9500 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9501
9502To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9503and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9504
9505 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9506 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9507 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9508 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9509
9510 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9511 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9512 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9513 use_backend www if host_www
9514
9515It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9516expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9517be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9518the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9519
9520 The following rule :
9521
9522 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9523 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9524
9525 Can also be written that way :
9526
9527 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9528
9529It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9530to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9531simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9532sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9533good use is the following :
9534
9535 With named ACLs :
9536
9537 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9538 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9539 monitor fail if site_dead
9540
9541 With anonymous ACLs :
9542
9543 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9544
9545See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9546
9547
95487.3. Fetching samples
9549---------------------
9550
9551Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9552against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9553sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9554ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9555of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9556available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9557
9558This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9559Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9560compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9561deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9562
9563The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9564matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9565method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9566indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9567
9568As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9569when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9570mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9571the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9572ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9573
9574Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9575multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9576when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9577incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9578are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9579is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9580all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9581
9582Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9583 - name
9584 - name(arg1)
9585 - name(arg1,arg2)
9586
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009587
95887.3.1. Converters
9589-----------------
9590
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009591Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9592of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9593is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9594was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9595has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9596unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9597
9598These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9599sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9600the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9601support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009603The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009604
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009605base64
9606 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9607 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9608 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9609
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009610lower
9611 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9612 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9613 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009614
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009615upper
9616 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9617 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9618 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009619
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009620hex
9621 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9622 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9623 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9624 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009626ipmask(<mask>)
9627 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9628 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9629 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9630 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009632http_date([<offset>])
9633 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9634 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9635 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9636 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9637 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9638 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009640language(<value>[,<default>])
9641 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9642 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9643 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9644 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9645 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9646 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9647 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9648 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9649 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9650 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9651 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9652 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009653
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009654 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009655
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009656 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9657 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009658
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009659 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9660 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9661 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9662 use_backend spanish if es
9663 use_backend french if fr
9664 use_backend english if en
9665 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009666
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009667map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9668map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9669map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9670 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9671 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9672 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9673 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9674 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9675 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9676 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9677 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009679 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9680 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9681 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009683 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9684 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009685
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009686 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9687 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9688 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9689 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9690 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9691 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9692 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9693 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9694 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9695 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9696 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9697 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9698 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9699 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9700 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9701 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9702 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9703 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009704
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009705 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9706 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9707 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9708 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9709 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009710
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009711 Example :
9712
9713 # this is a comment and is ignored
9714 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9715 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9716 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9717 | | | `---------- value
9718 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9719 | `---------------------------- key
9720 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9721
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009722
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020097237.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009724--------------------------------------------
9725
9726A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9727not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9728"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9729The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9730
9731always_false : boolean
9732 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9733 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9734
9735always_true : boolean
9736 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9737 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9738
9739avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009740 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009741 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9742 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9743 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9744 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9745 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9746 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9747 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9748 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9749 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9750 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9751 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9752 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9753 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009755be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009756 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9757 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9758 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9759 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9760 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009762be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9764 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9765 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9766 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9767 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9768 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009769
9770 Example :
9771 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9772 backend dynamic
9773 mode http
9774 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9775 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009777connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9778 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009779 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009780 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9781 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009782
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009783 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009784 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009785 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009787 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9788 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009789
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009790 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009791 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009792 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009793 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9794 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009795 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009796 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009797
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009798 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9799 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009800 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009801 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009802
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009803date([<offset>]) : integer
9804 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9805 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9806 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9807 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009808 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9809
9810 Example :
9811
9812 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9813 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009814
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009815env(<name>) : string
9816 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9817 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9818 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9819 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9820 certain way.
9821
9822 Examples :
9823 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9824 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9825
9826 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9827 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009829fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9830 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009831 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9832 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9834 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9835 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9836 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9837 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009839fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9840 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9841 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9842 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9843 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9844 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9845 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9846 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9847 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009848
9849 Example :
9850 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9851 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9852 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9853 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9854 frontend mail
9855 bind :25
9856 mode tcp
9857 maxconn 100
9858 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9859 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9860 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9861 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9864 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9865 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9866 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009867 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9868 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9869 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009872 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9873 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9874 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009875 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9876 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9877 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9878 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9879 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9880
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009881rand([<range>]) : integer
9882 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9883 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9884 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9885 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9886 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009888srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9889 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9890 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9891 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9892 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9893 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9894 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9895 methods.
9896
9897srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9898 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9899 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9900 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9901 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9902 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9903 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9904 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9905
9906srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9907 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9908 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009909 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9911 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9912 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9913 overloading servers).
9914
9915 Example :
9916 # Redirect to a separate back
9917 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9918 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9919 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9920
9921table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9922 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9923 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9924
9925table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9926 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9927 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9928 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9929
9930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020099317.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009932----------------------------------
9933
9934The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9935closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9936methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9937sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9938TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009939the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9940counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9941"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009942argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9943the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9944this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009945
9946be_id : integer
9947 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9948 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9949
9950dst : ip
9951 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9952 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9953 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9954 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9955 RFC 4291.
9956
9957dst_conn : integer
9958 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9959 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9960 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9961 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9962 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9963 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9964 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9965 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009967dst_port : integer
9968 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9969 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9970 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9971 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9972 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9973 an HTTP header.
9974
9975fe_id : integer
9976 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9977 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9978 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9979
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009980sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009981sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9982sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9983sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009984 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9985 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9986 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009988sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009989sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9990sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9991sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009992 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9993 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9994 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009996sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009997sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9998sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9999sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010000 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10001 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010002 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10003 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10004 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010005
10006 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10007 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010008 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10009 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10010 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010011 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10012 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10013
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010014sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010015sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10016sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10017sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010018 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10019 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10020
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010021sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010022sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10023sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10024sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010025 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10026 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10027 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10028
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010029sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010030sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10031sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10032sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010033 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10034 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10035 See also src_conn_rate.
10036
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010037sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010038sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10039sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10040sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010041 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010042 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010044sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010045sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10046sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10047sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010048 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10049 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10050 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010051 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10052 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10053 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010054
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010055sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010056sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10057sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10058sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010059 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10060 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10061 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10062
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010063sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010064sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10065sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10066sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010067 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10068 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10069 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10070 src_http_err_rate.
10071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010072sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010073sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10074sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10075sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010076 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10077 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10078 src_http_req_cnt.
10079
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010080sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010081sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10082sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10083sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010084 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10085 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10086 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10087 src_http_req_rate.
10088
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010089sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010090sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10091sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10092sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010093 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010094 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10095 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10096 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10097 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010098
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010099 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10100 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010101 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10102
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010103sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010104sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10105sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10106sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010107 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10108 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10109 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10110 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010112sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010113sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10114sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10115sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010116 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10117 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10118 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10119 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010121sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010122sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10123sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10124sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010125 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10126 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10127 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10128 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010129 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10131
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010132sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010133sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10134sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10135sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010136 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10137 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10138 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10139 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10140 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010141 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010142
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010143sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010144sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10145sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10146sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010147 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10148 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10149 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10150
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010151sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010152sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10153sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10154sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010155 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10156 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010157 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010158 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10159 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010160 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10161 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10162 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164so_id : integer
10165 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10166 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10167 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010169src : ip
10170 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10171 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10172 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10173 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10174 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10175 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10176 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010177
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010178 Example:
10179 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10180 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10183 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10184 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10185 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010186 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10189 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10190 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010191 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010192 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10195 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10196 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10197 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10198 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10199 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10200 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010201
10202 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10203 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10204 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10205 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010206 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010207 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10208 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010210src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010211 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010213 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010214 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010217 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10219 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010220 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010222src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10223 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10224 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10225 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010226 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010228src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010229 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010231 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010232 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010234src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010235 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010237 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10238 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010239 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10240 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10241 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010243src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10244 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10245 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010246 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010247 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010248 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010250src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10251 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10252 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10253 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10254 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010255 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10258 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10259 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10260 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010261 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010263src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10264 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10265 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10266 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010267 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010268 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010270src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10271 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10272 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10273 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010274 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10276 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010277
10278 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010279 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010280 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10283 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10284 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10285 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10286 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010287 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10288 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10291 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10292 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010293 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10294 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010295 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010297src_port : integer
10298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10299 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10300 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10301 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10304 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010305 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10306 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10307 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010308 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010310src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10311 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10312 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10313 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10314 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010315 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10318 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10319 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10320 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10321 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10322 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10323 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10324 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10325 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010326
10327 Example :
10328 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10329 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10330 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10331 listen ssh
10332 bind :22
10333 mode tcp
10334 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010335 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010336 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010337 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010339srv_id : integer
10340 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10341 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10342 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010343
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010344
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103457.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010346----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10349closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10350when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10351usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010352future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010353
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010354ssl_bc : boolean
10355 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10356 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10357 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10358
10359ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10360 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10361 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10362
10363ssl_bc_cipher : string
10364 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10365 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10366
10367ssl_bc_protocol : string
10368 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10369 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10370
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010371ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010372 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010373 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10374 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010375
10376ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10377 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10378 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10379 if session was reused or not.
10380
10381ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10382 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10383 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010385ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10386 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10387 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10388 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10389 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10390 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10394 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10395 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10396 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010398ssl_c_err : integer
10399 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10400 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10401 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10402 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10403 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010405ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10407 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10408 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10409 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10410 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10411 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10412 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10413 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010415ssl_c_key_alg : string
10416 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10417 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10418 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010420ssl_c_notafter : string
10421 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10422 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10423 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010425ssl_c_notbefore : string
10426 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10427 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10428 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010430ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10431 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10432 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10433 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10434 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10435 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10436 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10437 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10438 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440ssl_c_serial : binary
10441 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10442 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10443 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010445ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10446 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10447 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10448 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010450ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10451 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10452 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10453 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010455ssl_c_used : boolean
10456 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10457 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459ssl_c_verify : integer
10460 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10461 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10462 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10463 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010465ssl_c_version : integer
10466 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10467 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10470 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10471 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10472 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10473 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010474 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010475 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10476 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10477 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010479ssl_f_key_alg : string
10480 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10481 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10482 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010484ssl_f_notafter : string
10485 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10486 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10487 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010489ssl_f_notbefore : string
10490 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10491 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10492 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010494ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10495 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10496 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10497 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10498 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10499 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10500 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10501 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10502 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504ssl_f_serial : binary
10505 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10506 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10507 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010508
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010509ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10510 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10511 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10512 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010514ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10515 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10516 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10517 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519ssl_f_version : integer
10520 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10521 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10522
10523ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010524 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10525 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10526 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010528 Example :
10529 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10530 listen http-https
10531 bind :80
10532 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10533 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10534
10535ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10536 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10537 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10538
10539ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010540 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10542 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10543 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10544 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10545 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10546 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10547 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10548 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010550ssl_fc_cipher : string
10551 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10552 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010555 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10556 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010557 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10558 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10559 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10560 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10563 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010564 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10565 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10566 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10567 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010570 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10572 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10573 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10574 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10575 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10576 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10577 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010579ssl_fc_protocol : string
10580 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10581 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010582
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010583ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010584 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010585 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10586 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010588ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10589 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10590 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10591 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10592 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010594ssl_fc_sni : string
10595 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10596 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10597 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10598 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10599 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10600
10601 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10602 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10603 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010604 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10605 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10609 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10612 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10613 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010614
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010615
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010619Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10620sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10621only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10622For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10623be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10624can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10625sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10626for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10627content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10630 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10631 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10632 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10635 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10636 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10637 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639req.len : integer
10640req_len : integer (deprecated)
10641 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10642 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10643 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10644 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10645 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10646 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10647 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10648 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10651 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010652 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10653 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10654 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10655 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657 ACL alternatives :
10658 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010660req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10661 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10662 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10663 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10664 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010666 ACL alternatives :
10667 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671req.proto_http : boolean
10672req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10673 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10674 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10675 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10676 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10677 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10678 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10679 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010681 Example:
10682 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10683 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10684 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010685 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010687req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10688rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10689 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10690 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10691 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10692 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10693 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10694 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10695 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010697 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10698 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10699 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10700 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10701 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10702 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010704 ACL derivatives :
10705 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010707 Example :
10708 listen tse-farm
10709 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10710 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10711 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10712 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10713 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10714 persist rdp-cookie
10715 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10716 # This is only useful makes sense if
10717 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10718 stick-table type string size 204800
10719 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10720 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10721 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010723 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10724 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010726req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10727rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10728 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10729 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10730 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10731 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733 ACL derivatives :
10734 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010736req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10737req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10738 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10739 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10740 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10741 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10742 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10743 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10744 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010746req.ssl_sni : string
10747req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10748 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10749 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10750 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10751 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10752 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10753 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10754 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10755 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10756 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10757 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10758 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10759 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010761 ACL derivatives :
10762 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764 Examples :
10765 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10766 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10767 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10768 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10769 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10772rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10773 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10774 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10775 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10776 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10777 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10778 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10779 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010781req.ssl_ver : integer
10782req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10783 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10784 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10785 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10786 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10787 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10788 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10789 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10790 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10791 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010793 ACL derivatives :
10794 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010796res.len : integer
10797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10798 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10799 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10800 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10801 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10802 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10803 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10804 content inspection.
10805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10807 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010808 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10809 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10810 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10811 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10814 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10815 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10816 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10817 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821wait_end : boolean
10822 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10823 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10824 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10825 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10826 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10827 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10828 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10829 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010831 Examples :
10832 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10833 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10834 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010836 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10837 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10838 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10839 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10840 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10841 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10842 tcp-request content reject
10843
10844
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010846--------------------------------------
10847
10848It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10849This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10850data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10851its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10852HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10853content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10854to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10855more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10856response are indexed.
10857
10858base : string
10859 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10860 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10861 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10862 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10863 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10864 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10865 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10866 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10867
10868 ACL derivatives :
10869 base : exact string match
10870 base_beg : prefix match
10871 base_dir : subdir match
10872 base_dom : domain match
10873 base_end : suffix match
10874 base_len : length match
10875 base_reg : regex match
10876 base_sub : substring match
10877
10878base32 : integer
10879 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10880 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10881 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10882 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10883
10884base32+src : binary
10885 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10886 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10887 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10888 per-URL counters.
10889
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010890capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10891 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10892 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10893 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10894
10895capture.req.method : string
10896 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10897 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10898 because it's allocated.
10899
10900capture.req.uri : string
10901 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10902 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10903 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10904 allocated.
10905
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010906capture.req.ver : string
10907 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10908 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
10909 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
10910
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010911capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10912 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10913 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10914 The first entry is an index of 0.
10915 See also: "capture response header"
10916
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010917capture.res.ver : string
10918 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10919 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
10920 persistent flag.
10921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922req.cook([<name>]) : string
10923cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10924 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10925 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10926 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10927 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10928 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10929 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10930 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10931 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10932
10933 ACL derivatives :
10934 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10935 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10936 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10937 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10938 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10939 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10940 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10941 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10944cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10945 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10946 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010948req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10949cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10950 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10951 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10952 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10953 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010955cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10956 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10957 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10958 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10959 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10960 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10961 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10962 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10963 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10964 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10965 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010967hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10968 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10969 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10970 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10971 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010972 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010974req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10975 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10976 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10977 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10978 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10979 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10980 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10981 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10982 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010984req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10985 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10986 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10987 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10988 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010990req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10991 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10992 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10993 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10994 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10995 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10996 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10997 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10998 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10999 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11000 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11001 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003 ACL derivatives :
11004 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11005 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11006 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11007 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11008 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11009 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11010 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11011 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11012
11013req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11014hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11015 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11016 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11017 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11018 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11019 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11020 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11021 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11022 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11023 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11024
11025req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11026hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11027 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11028 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11029 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11030 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11031 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11032 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11033 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11034 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11035
11036req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11037hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11038 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11039 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11040 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11041 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11042 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11043 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11044 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11045
11046http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11047 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11048 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11049 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11050 basic auth is supported.
11051
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011052http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11053 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11054 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11055 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11056 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11058 basic auth is supported.
11059
11060 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011061 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11062 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11063 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11064 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011065
11066http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011067 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11068 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11070 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011072method : integer + string
11073 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11074 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11075 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11076 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11077 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11078 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11079 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011081 ACL derivatives :
11082 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 Example :
11085 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11086 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11087 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089path : string
11090 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11091 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11092 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11093 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11094 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11095 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11096 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011098 ACL derivatives :
11099 path : exact string match
11100 path_beg : prefix match
11101 path_dir : subdir match
11102 path_dom : domain match
11103 path_end : suffix match
11104 path_len : length match
11105 path_reg : regex match
11106 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108req.ver : string
11109req_ver : string (deprecated)
11110 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11111 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11112 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011114 ACL derivatives :
11115 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011117res.comp : boolean
11118 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11119 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11120 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122res.comp_algo : string
11123 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11124 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11125 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011127res.cook([<name>]) : string
11128scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11129 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11130 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11131 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011133 ACL derivatives :
11134 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11137scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11138 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11139 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11140 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011142res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11143scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11144 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11145 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11146 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011148res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11149 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11150 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11151 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11152 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11153 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11154 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11155 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11156 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11157 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011159res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11160 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11161 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11162 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11163 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11164 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011166res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11167shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11168 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11169 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11170 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11171 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11172 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11173 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11174 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11175 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011177 ACL derivatives :
11178 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11179 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11180 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11181 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11182 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11183 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11184 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11185 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11186
11187res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11188shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11189 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11190 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11191 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11192 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11193 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011195res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11196shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11197 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11198 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11199 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11200 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11201 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11202 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011204res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11205shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11206 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11207 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11208 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11209 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11210 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11211 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011213res.ver : string
11214resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11215 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11216 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011218 ACL derivatives :
11219 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011221set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11222 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11223 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11224 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11225 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11228 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011232status : integer
11233 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11234 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11235 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011237url : string
11238 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11239 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11240 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11241 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11242 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11243 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11244 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011246 ACL derivatives :
11247 url : exact string match
11248 url_beg : prefix match
11249 url_dir : subdir match
11250 url_dom : domain match
11251 url_end : suffix match
11252 url_len : length match
11253 url_reg : regex match
11254 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011256url_ip : ip
11257 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11258 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11259 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11260 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11261 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11262 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11263 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011265url_port : integer
11266 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11267 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11268 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11269 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011271urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11272url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11273 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11274 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11275 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11276 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11277 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11278 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11279 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11280 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11281 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011283 ACL derivatives :
11284 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11285 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11286 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11287 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11288 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11289 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11290 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11291 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011292
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294 Example :
11295 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11296 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11297 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11298 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11301 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11302 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11303 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011304
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113067.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011307---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011309Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11310every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011311order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011313ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11314---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011315FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011316HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011317HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11318HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011319HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11320HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11321HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11322HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11323LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011324METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11325METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11326METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11327METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11328METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11329METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011330RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011331REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011332TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011333WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11334---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011335
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113378. Logging
11338----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011340One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11341provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11342very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11343provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11344state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011345to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011346headers.
11347
11348In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11349about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11350send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11351
11352 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11353 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11354 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11355 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11356 at the termination.
11357
11358The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11359allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11360as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11361while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11362real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11363delay.
11364
11365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113668.1. Log levels
11367---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011368
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011369TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011370source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011371HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11372in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11373track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11374syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11375about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011376
11377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113788.2. Log formats
11379----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011380
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011381HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011382and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11383slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11384options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011385
11386 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11387 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11388 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11389 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11390 extents.
11391
11392 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11393 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11394 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11395 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11396 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11397
11398 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11399 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11400 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11401 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11402 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11403
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011404 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11405 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11406 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11407 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11408
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011409 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011411Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11412specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11413field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11414servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11415always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11416identifier.
11417
11418Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11419 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11420 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11421 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11422 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11423
11424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114258.2.1. Default log format
11426-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011427
11428This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11429as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11430format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11431
11432 Example :
11433 listen www
11434 mode http
11435 log global
11436 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11437
11438 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11439 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11440 (www/HTTP)
11441
11442 Field Format Extract from the example above
11443 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11444 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11445 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11446 4 'to' to
11447 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11448 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11449
11450Detailed fields description :
11451 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11452 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11453 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11454 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11455 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11456 and processed the connection.
11457 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11458
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011459In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11460"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11461connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11462
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011463It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11464will eventually disappear.
11465
11466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114678.2.2. TCP log format
11468---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011469
11470The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11471is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11472information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11473counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11474emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11475environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11476the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11477sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011478specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11479not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11480fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11481marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011482
11483 Example :
11484 frontend fnt
11485 mode tcp
11486 option tcplog
11487 log global
11488 default_backend bck
11489
11490 backend bck
11491 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11492
11493 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11494 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11495 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11496
11497 Field Format Extract from the example above
11498 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11499 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11500 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11501 4 frontend_name fnt
11502 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11503 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11504 7 bytes_read* 212
11505 8 termination_state --
11506 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11507 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11508
11509Detailed fields description :
11510 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011511 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11512 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11513 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11514 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11515 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011516
11517 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011518 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11519 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11520 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011521
11522 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11523 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11524 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11525 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11526
11527 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11528 and processed the connection.
11529
11530 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11531 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11532 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11533 applications.
11534
11535 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11536 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11537 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11538 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11539 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11540
11541 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11542 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11543 See "Timers" below for more details.
11544
11545 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11546 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11547 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11548 "Timers" below for more details.
11549
11550 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011551 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011552 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11553 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11554 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11555 details.
11556
11557 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11558 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11559 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11560 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11561 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11562
11563 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11564 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11565 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11566 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11567 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11568 for more details.
11569
11570 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011571 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011572 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11573 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11574 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011575 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011576
11577 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11578 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11579 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11580 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11581 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11582 caused by a denial of service attack.
11583
11584 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11585 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11586 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11587 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11588 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11589 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11590 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11591 denial of service attack.
11592
11593 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11594 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11595 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11596 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11597 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11598 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11599 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11600 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11601 be processed than on other servers.
11602
11603 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11604 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11605 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11606 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11607 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11608 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11609 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11610 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11611 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11612 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11613 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11614 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11615 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11616
11617 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11618 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11619 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11620 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11621 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11622 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11623 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11624 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11625
11626 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11627 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11628 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11629 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11630 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11631 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11632 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11633 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11634 occurs.
11635
11636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116378.2.3. HTTP log format
11638----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011639
11640The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11641is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11642the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11643are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11644emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11645generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11646"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11647which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011648frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11649is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011650
11651Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11652slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11653with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11654
11655 Example :
11656 frontend http-in
11657 mode http
11658 option httplog
11659 log global
11660 default_backend bck
11661
11662 backend static
11663 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11664
11665 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11666 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11667 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011668 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011669
11670 Field Format Extract from the example above
11671 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11672 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11673 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11674 4 frontend_name http-in
11675 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11676 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11677 7 status_code 200
11678 8 bytes_read* 2750
11679 9 captured_request_cookie -
11680 10 captured_response_cookie -
11681 11 termination_state ----
11682 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11683 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11684 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11685 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11686 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011688
11689Detailed fields description :
11690 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011691 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11692 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11693 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11694 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11695 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011696
11697 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011698 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11699 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11700 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011701
11702 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11703 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11704 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11705 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11706 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11707
11708 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11709 and processed the connection.
11710
11711 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11712 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11713 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11714
11715 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11716 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11717 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11718 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11719 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11720 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11721
11722 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11723 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11724 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11725 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11726 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11727 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11728
11729 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11730 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11731 See "Timers" below for more details.
11732
11733 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11734 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11735 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11736 below for more details.
11737
11738 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11739 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11740 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11741 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11742 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11743 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11744 for more details.
11745
11746 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011747 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011748 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11749 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11750 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11751 details.
11752
11753 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11754 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11755 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11756
11757 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11758 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11759 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11760 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11761 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11762 overflowing.
11763
11764 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11765 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11766 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11767 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11768 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11769 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11770 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11771 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11772
11773 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11774 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11775 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11776 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11777 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11778 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11779 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11780 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11781
11782 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11783 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11784 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11785 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11786 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11787 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11788 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11789
11790 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011791 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011792 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11793 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11794 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011795 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011796 system.
11797
11798 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11799 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11800 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11801 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11802 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11803 caused by a denial of service attack.
11804
11805 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11806 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11807 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11808 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11809 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11810 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11811 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11812 denial of service attack.
11813
11814 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11815 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11816 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11817 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11818 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11819 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11820 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11821 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11822 processed than on other servers.
11823
11824 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11825 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11826 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11827 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11828 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11829 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11830 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11831 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11832 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11833 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11834 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11835 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11836 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11837
11838 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11839 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11840 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11841 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11842 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11843 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11844 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11845 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11846
11847 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11848 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11849 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11850 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11851 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11852 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11853 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11854 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11855 occurs.
11856
11857 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11858 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11859 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11860 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11861 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11862 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11863 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11864 cookies" below for more details.
11865
11866 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11867 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11868 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11869 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11870 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11871 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11872 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11873 and cookies" below for more details.
11874
11875 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11876 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11877 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11878 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11879 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11880 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11881 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11882 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11883
11884
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200118858.2.4. Custom log format
11886------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011887
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011888The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011889mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011890
11891HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11892Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11893separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11894prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11895
11896Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11897variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11898string formats ("Q").
11899
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011900If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011901as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011902less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11903the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11904
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011905Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011906In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011907in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011908
11909Flags are :
11910 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011911 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011912
11913 Example:
11914
11915 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11916 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11917
11918At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11919
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011920 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11921 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011922
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011923the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011924
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011925 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011926 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011927 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011928
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011929and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11930
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011931 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011932 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11933
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011934Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11935
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011936 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011937 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011938 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11939 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11940 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011941 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11942 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11943 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011944 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011945 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011946 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011947 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011948 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011949 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011950 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11951 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011952 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011953 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11954 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011955 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011956 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11957 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011958 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11959 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11960 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011961 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011962 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11963 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011964 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011965 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11966 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11967 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011968 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011969 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11970 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11971 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11972 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011973 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011974 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011975 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011976 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011977 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011978 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011979 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11980 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11981 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011982 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011983 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11984 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011985 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011986 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011987 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011988 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011989
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011990 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011991
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011992
119938.2.5. Error log format
11994-----------------------
11995
11996When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11997protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11998By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11999"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12000will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12001logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12002
12003The format looks like this :
12004
12005 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12006 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12007 Connection error during SSL handshake
12008
12009 Field Format Extract from the example above
12010 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12011 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12012 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12013 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12014 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12015
12016These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12017failures.
12018
12019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120208.3. Advanced logging options
12021-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012022
12023Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12024just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12025options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12026for more information about their usage.
12027
12028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120298.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12030------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012031
12032It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12033haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12034commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12035monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12036ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12037
12038 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12039 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12040 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12041 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12042
12043 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12044 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12045 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012046 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012047 such as other load-balancers.
12048
12049 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12050 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12051 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12052
12053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120548.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12055----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012056
12057The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12058what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12059or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12060"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12061just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12062log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12063after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12064is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12065with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12066with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12067
12068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120698.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12070------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012071
12072Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12073for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12074"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12075retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12076raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12077a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12078file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12079you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12080"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12081
12082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12084--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012085
12086Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12087multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12088them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12089"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12090logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12091error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12092and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12093too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12094useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12095alternative.
12096
12097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120988.4. Timing events
12099------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100
12101Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12102reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12103the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12104frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12105mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12106
12107 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12108 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12109 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12110 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12111 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12112
12113 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12114 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12115 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12116 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12117 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12118
12119 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12120 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12121 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12122 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12123 connection never established.
12124
12125 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12126 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12127 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12128 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12129 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12130 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12131 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12132 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12133 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12134 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12135 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12136
12137 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12138 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12139 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12140 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012141 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012142
12143 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12144
12145 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12146 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12147 negative.
12148
12149These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12150protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12151that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012152due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012153close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12154session has been aborted on timeout.
12155
12156Most common cases :
12157
12158 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12159 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12160 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12161 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12162 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12163 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12164 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12165 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12166 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012167 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12168 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12169 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012170
12171 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12172 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12173 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12174 of ms on remote networks.
12175
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012176 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12177 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12178 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012179
12180 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12181 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12182 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12183 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12184 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12185 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12186 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12187 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12188 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12189 to the server until another one is released.
12190
12191Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12192
12193 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12194 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12195 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12196
12197 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12198 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12199 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12200
12201 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12202 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12203 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12204 flags.
12205
12206 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12207 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12208 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12209 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12210 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12211 the client connection was maintained open.
12212
12213 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012214 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012215 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12216 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12217
12218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122198.5. Session state at disconnection
12220-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012221
12222TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12223"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
122242-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12225each of which has a special meaning :
12226
12227 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12228 session to terminate :
12229
12230 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12231
12232 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12233 server explicitly refused it.
12234
12235 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12236 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12237 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12238 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012239 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12240
12241 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12242 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012243
12244 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12245 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12246 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12247 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12248 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12249
12250 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12251 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12252 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12253 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12254 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12255
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012256 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12257 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12258
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012259 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12260 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12261 backup connections when going up.
12262
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012263 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12264
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012265 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12266 send or receive data.
12267
12268 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12269 send or receive data.
12270
12271 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12272 with nothing left in the buffers.
12273
12274 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12275
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012276 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012277 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12278
12279 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12280 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12281 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12282 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12283 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12284
12285 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12286 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12287
12288 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12289 server (HTTP only).
12290
12291 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12292
12293 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12294 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12295 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12296
12297 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12298 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12299 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12300
12301 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12302
12303 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12304 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12305
12306 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12307 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12308 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12309
12310 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12311 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012312 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12313 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012314
12315 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12316 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12317 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12318 another server.
12319
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012320 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012321 server.
12322
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012323 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12324 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12325 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12326 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12327
12328 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12329 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12330 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12331 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12332
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012333 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12334 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12335 "use-server" rule).
12336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012337 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12338
12339 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12340 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12341
12342 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12343
12344 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12345 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12346 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12347
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012348 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12349 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012350 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012351 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12352 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12353
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012354 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12355
12356 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12357 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12358
12359 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12360
12361 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12362
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012363The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12364was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012365helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12366starvation, attacks, etc...
12367
12368The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12369alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12370easier finding and understanding.
12371
12372 Flags Reason
12373
12374 -- Normal termination.
12375
12376 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12377 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12378 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12379 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12380
12381 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12382 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12383 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12384 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12385 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12386 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012387
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012388 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12389 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012390 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012391
12392 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12393 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12394 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12395
12396 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12397 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12398 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12399 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12400 the server takes too long to respond.
12401
12402 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12403 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12404 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12405 long a time to respond.
12406
12407 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12408 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12409 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12410 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12411 and the client.
12412
12413 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12414 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12415 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12416 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12417 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12418 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12419
12420 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12421 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012422 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12423 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12424 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12425 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012426
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012427 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12428 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012430 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012431 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12432 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12433 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12434 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12435 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12436
12437 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12438 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12439 503 or 504 here.
12440
12441 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12442 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12443 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12444 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12445 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12446
12447 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12448 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012449 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012450 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12451 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12452
12453 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12454 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12455 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12456 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12457 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12458 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12459 between haproxy and the server.
12460
12461 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12462 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12463 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12464 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12465 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12466 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12467 solution is to fix the application.
12468
12469 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12470 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12471 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12472 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12473 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12474 external attacks.
12475
12476 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12477 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012478 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012479 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12480 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12481
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012482 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12483 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12484 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012485 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12486 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012487
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012488 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12489 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12490 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12491 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012492 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12493 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12494 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12495 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12496 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012497
12498 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12499 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12500 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12501 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12502
12503 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12504 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12505 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12506 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12507
12508 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12509 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12510 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12511 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12512
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012513The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12514persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12515important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12516re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12517
12518 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12519
12520 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12521 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12522 set on a GET request.
12523
12524 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12525 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012526 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012527 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12528
12529 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12530 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12531 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12532
12533 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12534 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12535 already got a cookie.
12536
12537 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12538 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12539 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12540 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12541 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12542
12543 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12544 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12545 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12546
12547 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12548 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12549 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12550
12551 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12552 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12553
12554 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12555 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12556 then advertised in the response.
12557
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125598.6. Non-printable characters
12560-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012561
12562In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12563consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12564converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12565prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12566being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12567escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12568is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12569'}' when logging headers.
12570
12571Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12572issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12573containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12574
12575Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12576the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12577performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12578
12579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12581---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012582
12583Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12584achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012585section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012586cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12587the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12588the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012589locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012590not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12591user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12592a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12593wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12594
12595 Examples :
12596 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12597 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12598
12599 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12600 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12601
12602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12604---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012605
12606Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12607proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12608the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12609server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12610
12611Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12612response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012613section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012614
12615It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012616time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12617appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012618are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12619and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12620follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12621request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12622in the logs.
12623
12624 Example :
12625 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12626 listen proxy-out
12627 mode http
12628 option httplog
12629 option logasap
12630 log global
12631 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12632
12633 # log the name of the virtual server
12634 capture request header Host len 20
12635
12636 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12637 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12638
12639 # log the beginning of the referrer
12640 capture request header Referer len 20
12641
12642 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12643 capture response header Server len 20
12644
12645 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12646 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12647
12648 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12649 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12650
12651 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12652 capture response header Via len 20
12653
12654 # log the URL location during a redirection
12655 capture response header Location len 20
12656
12657 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12658 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12659 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12660 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12661 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12662
12663 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12664 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12665 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12666 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012667 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012668
12669 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12670 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12671 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12672 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12673 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012674 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012675
12676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126778.9. Examples of logs
12678---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012679
12680These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12681them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12682reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12683
12684 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12685 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12686 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12687
12688 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12689 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12690
12691 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12692 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12693 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12694
12695 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12696 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12697
12698 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12699 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12700 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12701
12702 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012703 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012704 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12705 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12706
12707 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12708 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12709 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12710
12711 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12712 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012713 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012714 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12715 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12716 to return the 502 and not the server.
12717
12718 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012719 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012720
12721 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12722 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12723 Nothing was sent to any server.
12724
12725 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12726 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12727
12728 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12729 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12730 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12731 send a 408 return code to the client.
12732
12733 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12734 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12735
12736 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12737 5 seconds ("c----").
12738
12739 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12740 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012741 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012742
12743 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012744 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012745 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12746 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12747 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12748 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12749 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012750
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127529. Statistics and monitoring
12753----------------------------
12754
12755It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12756mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12757CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12758Unix socket.
12759
12760
127619.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012762---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012763
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012764The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12765page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012767 0. pxname: proxy name
12768 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12769 for server)
12770 2. qcur: current queued requests
12771 3. qmax: max queued requests
12772 4. scur: current sessions
12773 5. smax: max sessions
12774 6. slim: sessions limit
12775 7. stot: total sessions
12776 8. bin: bytes in
12777 9. bout: bytes out
12778 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012779 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012780 12. ereq: request errors
12781 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012782 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012783 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12784 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012785 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012786 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12787 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12788 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12789 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12790 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12791 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12792 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12793 25. qlimit: queue limit
12794 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12795 27. iid: unique proxy id
12796 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12797 29. throttle: warm up status
12798 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12799 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012800 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012801 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12802 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12803 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012804 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012805 UNK -> unknown
12806 INI -> initializing
12807 SOCKERR -> socket error
12808 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12809 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12810 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12811 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12812 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12813 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12814 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12815 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12816 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12817 disable-on-404
12818 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12819 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12820 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012821 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12822 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012823 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12824 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12825 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12826 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12827 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12828 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012829 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12830 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12831 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12832 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012833 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12834 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012835 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12836 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12837 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012838 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012839 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012840
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128429.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012843-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012844
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012845The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12846necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12847A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12848issuing commands by hand :
12849
12850 global
12851 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12852 stats timeout 2m
12853
12854It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12855the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12856never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12857situations :
12858
12859 global
12860 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12861 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12862 stats timeout 2m
12863
12864To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12865swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12866to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12867syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12868
12869 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12870 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12871
12872The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12873script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12874for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12875
12876The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12877that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12878editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12879(eg: watch a counter).
12880
12881The socket supports two operation modes :
12882 - interactive
12883 - non-interactive
12884
12885The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12886this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12887sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12888mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12889commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12890example :
12891
12892 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12893
12894The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12895entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12896for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12897sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12898"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12899after processing the last command of the same line.
12900
12901For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12902"prompt" command :
12903
12904 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12905 prompt
12906 > show info
12907 ...
12908 >
12909
12910Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12911delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12912that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12913parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012914
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012915It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12916on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12917own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012918
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012919The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12920If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12921all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12922it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12923
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012924add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012925 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12926 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12927 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12928 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012929
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012930add map <map> <key> <value>
12931 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12932 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012933 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12934 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12935 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012936
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012937clear counters
12938 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12939 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12940 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12941 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12942 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12943
12944clear counters all
12945 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12946 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12947 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12948
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012949clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012950 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12951 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12952 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012953
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012954clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012955 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12956 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12957 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012958
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012959clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12960 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12961
12962 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12963 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12964 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12965 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12966 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12967 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12968
12969 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12970
12971 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12972 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12973 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12974 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12975 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12976 the ACLs :
12977
12978 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12979 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12980 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12981 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12982 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12983 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12984
12985 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012986 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12987 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012988
12989 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012990 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012991 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012992 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12993 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12994 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12995 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012996
12997 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12998
12999 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013000 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013001 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13002 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013003 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13004 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13005 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013006
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013007del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13008 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013009 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13010 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13011 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13012 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013013
13014del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013015 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013016 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13017 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13018 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13019 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013020
13021disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013022 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13023
13024 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13025 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13026 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13027 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13028 re-enabled using enable agent.
13029
13030 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13031 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13032 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13033 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13034 otherwise unchanged.
13035
13036 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13037 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13038 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13039
13040 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13041 level "admin".
13042
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013043disable frontend <frontend>
13044 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13045 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13046 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13047 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13048 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13049 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13050 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13051 on the stats page.
13052
13053 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13054 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13055
13056 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13057 level "admin".
13058
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013059disable server <backend>/<server>
13060 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13061 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13062 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13063 during the maintenance.
13064
13065 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13066 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13067
13068 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013069 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013070
13071 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13072 level "admin".
13073
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013074enable agent <backend>/<server>
13075 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13076
13077 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13078 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13079
13080 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13081 level "admin".
13082
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013083enable frontend <frontend>
13084 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13085 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13086 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13087 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13088 which was disabled.
13089
13090 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13091 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13092
13093 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13094 level "admin".
13095
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013096enable server <backend>/<server>
13097 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13098 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13099
13100 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013101 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013102
13103 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13104 level "admin".
13105
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013106get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013107get acl <acl> <value>
13108 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13109 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13110 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13111 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13112 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013113
13114 The first two words are:
13115
13116 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13117 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13118 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13119
13120 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13121
13122 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13123
13124 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13125
13126 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13127 interpretation of the case.
13128
13129 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13130 useful with regular expressions.
13131
13132 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13133 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13134
13135 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13136 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13137 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13138
13139 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13140
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013141get weight <backend>/<server>
13142 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13143 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13144 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13145 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13146 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013147 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013148
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013149help
13150 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13151 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013152
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013153prompt
13154 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13155 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13156 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13157 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13158 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13159 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13160 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13161 command.
13162
13163quit
13164 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013165
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013166set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013167 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13168 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13169 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013170
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013171set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013172 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13173 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13174 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13175 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13176 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013177 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13178 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13179
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013180set maxconn global <maxconn>
13181 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13182 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13183 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13184 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13185 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13186 setting.
13187
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013188set rate-limit connections global <value>
13189 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13190 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13191 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13192 is passed in number of connections per second.
13193
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013194set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13195 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13196 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013197 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13198 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013199
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013200set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13201 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13202 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13203 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13204 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13205
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013206set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13207 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13208 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13209 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13210 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13211 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13212
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013213set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013214 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13215 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13216 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13217 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013218 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13219 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013220
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013221set timeout cli <delay>
13222 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13223 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13224 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13225
13226set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13227 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13228 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013229 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13230 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13231 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13232 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13233 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13234 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13235 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13236 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13237 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13238 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13239 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13240 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13241 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013242
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013243show errors [<iid>]
13244 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13245 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013246 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13247 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13248 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013249
13250 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13251 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13252 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13253 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13254 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13255 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13256 are reported too.
13257
13258 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13259 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13260 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13261 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13262 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13263 code.
13264
13265 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13266 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13267 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13268 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13269 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13270 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13271 line.
13272
13273 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013274 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13275 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013276 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13277 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13278
13279 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13280 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13281 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13282 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13283 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13284 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13285 00204+ minal\r\n
13286 00211 \r\n
13287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013288 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013289 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13290 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13291 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13292 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13293 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13294 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013295
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013296show info
13297 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13298
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013299show map [<map>]
13300 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013301 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13302 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13303 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13304 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13305 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13306 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013307
13308show acl [<acl>]
13309 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013310 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13311 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13312 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13313 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13314 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013315
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013316show pools
13317 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13318 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13319 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13320 the pools.
13321
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013322show sess
13323 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013324 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13325 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13326
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013327show sess <id>
13328 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13329 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13330 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13331 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13332 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013333 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13334 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13335 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013336
13337show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13338 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13339 possible to dump only selected items :
13340 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13341 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13342 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13343 for example:
13344 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13345 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13346 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13347
13348 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013349 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13350 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013351 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13352 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13353 Nbproc: 1
13354 Process_num: 1
13355 (...)
13356
13357 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13358 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13359 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13360 (...)
13361 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13362
13363 $
13364
13365 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13366 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13367 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13368 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013369 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013370
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013371show table
13372 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13373 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13374 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13375 entries currently in use.
13376
13377 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013378 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013379 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13380 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013381
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013382show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013383 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13384 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13385 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013386 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13387
13388 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13389 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13390 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13391 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13392 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13393
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013394 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13395 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13396 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13397 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13398 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13399 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13400
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013401
13402 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013403 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13404 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013405
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013406 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013407 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013408 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013409 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13410 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13411 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13412 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013413
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013414 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013415 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013416 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13417 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013418
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013419 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13420 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013421 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013422 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13423 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013424
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013425 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13426 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013427 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013428 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13429 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13430
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013431 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13432 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13433 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13434 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13435 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13436
13437 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13438 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13439 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013440 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13441 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013442 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13443 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013444
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013445shutdown frontend <frontend>
13446 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13447 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13448 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13449 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13450 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13451 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13452 once it is terminated.
13453
13454 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13455 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13456
13457 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13458 level "admin".
13459
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013460shutdown session <id>
13461 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13462 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13463 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13464 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13465 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13466 flag in the logs.
13467
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013468shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13469 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13470 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13471 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13472 'K' flag in the logs.
13473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013474/*
13475 * Local variables:
13476 * fill-column: 79
13477 * End:
13478 */